Goldman Sachs
GS
#55
Rank
$270.10 B
Marketcap
$892.27
Share price
-1.36%
Change (1 day)
39.60%
Change (1 year)

Goldman Sachs - 10-Q quarterly report FY2010 Q1


Text size:
Table of Contents

 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
 
 
 
FORM 10-Q
 
   
x
 QUARTERLY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934.
   
  For the quarterly period ended March 31, 2010
 
or
   
o
 TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934.
   
  For the transition period from                        to
 
Commission File Number:001-14965
 
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 
   
Delaware 13-4019460
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
 (I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
   
200 West Street, New York, NY 10282
(Address of principal executive offices) (Zip Code)
 
(212) 902-1000
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.     x  Yes  o  No
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 ofRegulation S-T(§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).     x  Yes  o  No
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, anon-acceleratedfiler, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” inRule 12b-2of the Exchange Act.
 
Large accelerated filer x   Accelerated filer o
 
Non-acceleratedfiler o (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)  Smaller reporting company o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined inRule 12b-2of the Exchange Act).     o  Yes  x  No
 
APPLICABLE ONLY TO CORPORATE ISSUERS
 
As of April 23, 2010, there were 514,788,856 shares of the registrant’s common stock outstanding.
 


 

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC.
 
QUARTERLY REPORT ONFORM 10-QFOR THE FISCAL QUARTER ENDED MARCH 31, 2010
 
INDEX
 
       
    Page
Form 10-QItem Number:   No.  
 
      
     
      
     
    2 
    3 
    4 
    5 
    6 
    7 
    79 
    80 
      
   83 
      
   137 
      
   137 
      
     
      
   138 
      
   142 
      
   143 
    
  144 
 EX-10.1: GENERAL GUARANTEE AGREEMENT BETWEEN GROUP INC AND GSEC
 EX-12.1: STATEMENT RE: COMPUTATION OF RATIOS OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES AND RATIOS OF EARNINGS TO COMBINED FIXED CHARGES AND PREFERRED STOCK DIVIDENDS
 EX-15.1: LETTER RE: UNAUDITED INTERIM FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 EX-31.1: RULE 13A-14(A) CERTIFICATIONS
 EX-32.1: SECTION 1350 CERTIFICATIONS
 EX-101 INSTANCE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 SCHEMA DOCUMENT
 EX-101 CALCULATION LINKBASE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 LABELS LINKBASE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 PRESENTATION LINKBASE DOCUMENT
 EX-101 DEFINITION LINKBASE DOCUMENT

1


Table of Contents

 
PART I: FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
Item 1:  Financial Statements (Unaudited)
 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
(UNAUDITED)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions, except
  per share amounts)
 
Revenues
        
Investment banking
 $1,184  $823 
Trading and principal investments
  9,195   5,706 
Asset management and securities services
  978   989 
         
Totalnon-interestrevenues
  11,357   7,518 
         
Interest income
  3,001   4,362 
Interest expense
  1,583   2,455 
         
Net interest income
  1,418   1,907 
         
Net revenues, including net interest income
  12,775   9,425 
         
         
Operating expenses
        
Compensation and benefits
  5,493   4,712 
         
Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees
  562   536 
Market development
  110   68 
Communications and technology
  176   173 
Depreciation and amortization
  372   549 
Occupancy
  256   241 
Professional fees
  182   135 
Other expenses
  465   382 
         
Totalnon-compensationexpenses
  2,123   2,084 
         
Total operating expenses
  7,616   6,796 
         
         
Pre-taxearnings
  5,159   2,629 
Provision for taxes
  1,703   815 
         
Net earnings
  3,456   1,814 
Preferred stock dividends
  160   155 
         
Net earnings applicable to common shareholders
 $3,296  $1,659 
         
Earnings per common share
        
Basic
 $6.02  $3.48 
Diluted
  5.59   3.39 
         
Dividends declared per common share
 $0.35  $ (1)
         
Average common shares outstanding
        
Basic
  546.0   477.4 
Diluted
  590.0   489.2 
 
 
(1) The firm declared a dividend of $0.4666666 per common share in December 2008, which was reflective of a four-month period (December 2008 through March 2009), due to the change in the firm’s fiscal year-end.
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.

2


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
(UNAUDITED)
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions, except share
  and per share amounts)
 
Assets
        
Cash and cash equivalents
 $27,064  $38,291 
Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes (includes $27,312 and $18,853 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  43,053   36,663 
Collateralized agreements:
        
Securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold (includes $166,368 and $144,279 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  166,368   144,279 
Securities borrowed (includes $71,349 and $66,329 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  202,841   189,939 
Receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
  13,557   12,597 
Receivables from customers and counterparties (includes $1,774 and $1,925 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  57,886   55,303 
Trading assets, at fair value (includes $43,281 and $31,485 pledged as collateral as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  339,435   342,402 
Other assets
  30,324   29,468 
         
Total assets
 $880,528  $848,942 
         
         
Liabilities and shareholders’ equity
        
Deposits (includes $2,014 and $1,947 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
 $38,431  $39,418 
Collateralized financings:
        
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
  153,517   128,360 
Securities loaned (includes $3,108 and $6,194 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  14,841   15,207 
Other secured financings (includes $15,986 and $15,228 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  24,037   24,134 
Payables to brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
  4,613   5,242 
Payables to customers and counterparties
  181,133   180,392 
Trading liabilities, at fair value
  140,081   129,019 
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings, including the current portion of unsecuredlong-termborrowings (includes $19,594 and $18,403 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  40,784   37,516 
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings (includes $20,187 and $21,392 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  180,414   185,085 
Other liabilities and accrued expenses (includes $2,782 and $2,054 at fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively)
  29,733   33,855 
         
Total liabilities
  807,584   778,228 
         
Commitments, contingencies and guarantees
        
         
Shareholders’ equity
        
Preferred stock, par value $0.01 per share; aggregate liquidation preference of $8,100 as of both March 2010 and December 2009
  6,957   6,957 
Common stock, par value $0.01 per share; 4,000,000,000 shares authorized, 765,392,931 and 753,412,247 shares issued as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, and 514,190,734 and 515,113,890 shares outstanding as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively
  8   8 
Restricted stock units and employee stock options
  5,934   6,245 
Nonvoting common stock, par value $0.01 per share; 200,000,000 shares authorized, no shares issued and outstanding
      
Additionalpaid-incapital
  41,444   39,770 
Retained earnings
  53,345   50,252 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
  (356)  (362)
Common stock held in treasury, at cost, par value $0.01 per share; 251,202,197 and 238,298,357 shares as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively
  (34,388)  (32,156)
         
Total shareholders’ equity
  72,944   70,714 
         
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 $880,528  $848,942 
         
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.

3


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
(UNAUDITED)
 
         
  Three Months
  
  Ended Year Ended
  March 2010 December 2009
  (in millions)
 
Preferred stock
        
Balance, beginning of year
 $6,957  $16,483 
Accretion
     48 
Repurchased
     (9,574)
         
Balance, end of period
  6,957   6,957 
Common stock
        
Balance, beginning of year
  8   7 
Issued
     1 
         
Balance, end of period
  8   8 
Restricted stock units and employee stock options
        
Balance, beginning of year
  6,245   9,463 
Issuance and amortization of restricted stock units and employee stock options
  2,186   2,064 
Delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units
  (2,455)  (5,206)
Forfeiture of restricted stock units and employee stock options
  (38)  (73)
Exercise of employee stock options
  (4)  (3)
         
Balance, end of period
  5,934   6,245 
Additionalpaid-incapital
        
Balance, beginning of year
  39,770   31,070 
Issuance of common stock
     5,750 
Repurchase of common stock warrants
     (1,100)
Delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units and proceeds from the exercise of employee stock options
  2,560   5,708 
Cancellation of restricted stock units in satisfaction of withholding tax requirements
  (962)  (863)
Excess net tax benefit/(provision) related toshare-basedcompensation
  76   (793)
Cash settlement ofshare-basedcompensation
     (2)
         
Balance, end of period
  41,444   39,770 
Retained earnings
        
Balance, beginning of year
  50,252   38,579 
Net earnings
  3,456   13,385 
Dividends and dividend equivalents declared on common stock and restricted stock units
  (203)  (588)
Dividends declared on preferred stock
  (160)  (1,076)
Preferred stock accretion
     (48)
         
Balance, end of period
  53,345   50,252 
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
        
Balance, beginning of year
  (362)  (372)
Currency translation adjustment, net of tax
  (4)  (70)
Pension and postretirement liability adjustments, net of tax
  6   (17)
Net unrealized gains onavailable-for-salesecurities, net of tax
  4   97 
         
Balance, end of period
  (356)  (362)
Common stock held in treasury, at cost
        
Balance, beginning of year
  (32,156)  (32,176)
Repurchased
  (2,269)  (2(1)
Reissued
  37   22 
         
Balance, end of period
  (34,388)  (32,156)
         
Total shareholders’ equity
 $72,944  $70,714 
         
 
(1) Relates primarily to repurchases of common stock by abroker-dealersubsidiary to facilitate customer transactions in the ordinary course of business and shares withheld to satisfy withholding tax requirements.
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.

4


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
(UNAUDITED)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
 
Cash flows from operating activities
        
Net earnings
 $3,456  $1,814 
Non-cashitems included in net earnings
        
Depreciation and amortization
  375   649 
Share-basedcompensation
  2,160   468 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
        
Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes
  (6,378)  43,126 
Net receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
  (1,540)  8,140 
Net payables to customers and counterparties
  (1,793)  (17,879)
Securities borrowed, net of securities loaned
  (13,269)  (27,552)
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, net of securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold
  3,068   (140,648)
Trading assets, at fair value
  6,986   180,563 
Trading liabilities, at fair value
  11,056   (38,810)
Other, net
  (11,625)  (6,674)
         
Net cash provided by/(used for) operating activities
  (7,504)  3,197 
Cash flows from investing activities
        
Purchase of property, leasehold improvements and equipment
  (278)  (278)
Proceeds from sales of property, leasehold improvements and equipment
  28   28 
Business acquisitions, net of cash acquired
  (699)  (190)
Proceeds from sales of investments
  173   75 
Purchase ofavailable-for-salesecurities
  (864)  (1,440)
Proceeds from sales ofavailable-for-salesecurities
  674   892 
         
Net cash used for investing activities
  (966)  (913)
Cash flows from financing activities
        
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings, net
  525   (4,680)
Other secured financings(short-term),net
  (312)  5,222 
Proceeds from issuance of other secured financings(long-term)
  1,541   2,322 
Repayment of other secured financings(long-term),including the current portion
  (1,880)  (2,435)
Proceeds from issuance of unsecuredlong-termborrowings
  6,081   14,689 
Repayment of unsecuredlong-termborrowings, including the current portion
  (5,584)  (8,325)
Derivative contracts with a financing element, net
  110   670 
Deposits, net
  (987)  12,374 
Common stock repurchased
  (2,269)  (2)
Dividends and dividend equivalents paid on common stock, preferred stock and restricted stock units
  (363)  (545)
Proceeds from issuance of common stock, including stock option exercises
  138   27 
Excess tax benefit related toshare-basedcompensation
  243   11 
         
Net cash provided by/(used for) financing activities
  (2,757)  19,328 
         
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
  (11,227)  21,612 
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year
  38,291   13,805 
         
Cash and cash equivalents, end of period
 $27,064  $35,417 
         
 
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES:
 
Cash payments for interest, net of capitalized interest, were $2.01 billion and $3.42 billion during the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively.
 
Cash payments for income taxes, net of refunds, were $778 million and $256 million during the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively.
 
Non-cashactivities:
The firm assumed $90 million and $16 million of debt in connection with business acquisitions during the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively. In addition, during the three months ended March 2010, the firm recorded an increase of approximately $3 billion in both assets (primarily trading assets, at fair value) and liabilities (primarily unsecuredshort-termborrowings and other liabilities) upon adoption of Accounting Standards Update (ASU)No. 2009-17,“Consolidations (Topic 810) — Improvements to Financial Reporting by Enterprises Involved with Variable Interest Entities.”
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.

5


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
(UNAUDITED)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
 
Net earnings
 $3,456  $1,814 
Currency translation adjustment, net of tax
  (4)  25 
Pension and postretirement liability adjustments, net of tax
  6   9 
Net unrealized gains/(losses) onavailable-for-salesecurities, net of tax
  4   (19)
         
Comprehensive income
 $3,462  $1,829 
         
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed consolidated financial statements.

6


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(UNAUDITED)
 
Note 1.  Description of Business
 
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc.), a Delaware corporation, together with its consolidated subsidiaries (collectively, the firm), is a leading global investment banking, securities and investment management firm that provides a wide range of financial services to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments andhigh-net-worthindividuals. Founded in 1869, the firm is headquartered in New York and maintains offices in London, Frankfurt, Tokyo, Hong Kong and other major financial centers around the world.
 
The firm’s activities are divided into three segments:
 
  • Investment Banking.  The firm provides a broad range of investment banking services to a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals.
 
  • Trading and Principal Investments.  The firm facilitates client transactions with a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals through market making in, trading of and investing in fixed income and equity products, currencies, commodities and derivatives on these products. The firm also takes proprietary positions on certain of these products. In addition, the firm engages inmarket-makingactivities on equities and options exchanges, and the firm clears client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide. In connection with the firm’s merchant banking and other investing activities, the firm makes principal investments directly and through funds that the firm raises and manages.
 
  • Asset Management and Securities Services.  The firm provides investment and wealth advisory services and offers investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and provides prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and tohigh-net-worthindividuals worldwide.
 
Note 2.  Significant Accounting Policies
 
Basis of Presentation
 
These condensed consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Group Inc. and all other entities in which the firm has a controlling financial interest. All material intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated.
 
The firm determines whether it has a controlling financial interest in an entity by first evaluating whether the entity is a voting interest entity or a variable interest entity (VIE) under generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP).
 
  • Voting Interest Entities.  Voting interest entities are entities in which (i) the total equity investment at risk is sufficient to enable the entity to finance its activities independently and (ii) the equity holders have the power to direct the activities of the entity that most significantly impact its economic performance, the obligation to absorb the losses of the entity and the right to receive the residual returns of the entity. The usual condition for a controlling financial interest in a voting interest entity is ownership of a majority voting interest. Accordingly, the firm consolidates voting interest entities in which it has a majority voting interest.

7


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
  • Variable Interest Entities.  VIEs are entities that lack one or more of the characteristics of a voting interest entity. A controlling financial interest in a VIE is present when an enterprise has a variable interest, or a combination of variable interests, that provides the enterprise with (i) the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance and (ii) the obligation to absorb losses of the VIE or the right to receive benefits from the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE. The enterprise with a controlling financial interest, known as the primary beneficiary, consolidates the VIE. The firm determines whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE by performing an analysis that principally considers: (i) the VIE’s purpose and design, including the risks the VIE was designed to create and pass through to its variable interest holders, (ii) the VIE’s capital structure, (iii) the terms between the VIE and its variable interest holders and other parties involved with the VIE, (iv) which variable interest holders have the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance, (v) which variable interest holders have the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits from the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE and (vi) related party relationships. The firm reassesses its initial evaluation of an entity as a VIE upon the occurrence of certain reconsideration events. The firm reassesses its determination of whether the firm is the primary beneficiary of a VIE upon changes in facts and circumstances that could potentially alter the firm’s assessment. See“— RecentAccounting Developments” below for further information regarding accounting for VIEs.
 
  • Equity-MethodInvestments.  When the firm does not have a controlling financial interest in an entity but exerts significant influence over the entity’s operating and financial policies (generally defined as owning a voting interest of 20% to 50%) and has an investment in common stock orin-substancecommon stock, the firm accounts for its investment either under the equity method of accounting or at fair value pursuant to the fair value option available under Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) Accounting Standards Codification (ASC)825-10. In general, the firm accounts for investments acquired subsequent to November 24, 2006, when the fair value option became available, at fair value. In certain cases, the firm applies the equity method of accounting to new investments that are strategic in nature or closely related to the firm’s principal business activities, where the firm has a significant degree of involvement in the cash flows or operations of the investee, or wherecost-benefitconsiderations are less significant. See“— RevenueRecognition — Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value” below for a discussion of the firm’s application of the fair value option.
 
  • Other.  If the firm does not consolidate an entity or apply the equity method of accounting, the firm accounts for its investment at fair value. The firm also has formed numerous nonconsolidated investment funds withthird-partyinvestors that are typically organized as limited partnerships. The firm acts as general partner for these funds and generally does not hold a majority of the economic interests in these funds. The firm has generally provided thethird-partyinvestors with rights to terminate the funds or to remove the firm as the general partner. As a result, the firm does not consolidate these funds. Investments in these funds are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.

8


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
These condensed consolidated financial statements are unaudited and should be read in conjunction with the audited consolidated financial statements included in the firm’s Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009. The condensed consolidated financial information as of December 31, 2009 has been derived from audited consolidated financial statements not included herein.
 
These unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements reflect all adjustments that are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair statement of the results for the interim periods presented. These adjustments are of a normal, recurring nature. Interim period operating results may not be indicative of the operating results for a full year.
 
All references to March 2010 and March 2009, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to the firm’s fiscal periods ended, or the dates, as the context requires, March 31, 2010 and March 27, 2009, respectively. Beginning with the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, the firm changed its fiscal year-end from the last Friday of December to December 31. All references to December 2009, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to the firm’s fiscal year ended, or the date, as the context requires, December 31, 2009. All references to 2010, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to the firm’s year ending, or the date, as the context requires, December 31, 2010. Certain reclassifications have been made to previously reported amounts to conform to the current presentation.
 
Use of Estimates
 
These condensed consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles that require management to make certain estimates and assumptions. The most important of these estimates and assumptions relate to fair value measurements, the accounting for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, discretionary compensation accruals and the provision for potential losses that may arise from litigation and regulatory proceedings and tax audits. Although these and other estimates and assumptions are based on the best available information, actual results could be materially different from these estimates.
 
Revenue Recognition
 
Investment Banking
 
Underwriting revenues and fees from mergers and acquisitions and other financial advisory assignments are recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings when the services related to the underlying transaction are completed under the terms of the engagement. Expenses associated with such transactions are deferred until the related revenue is recognized or the engagement is otherwise concluded. Underwriting revenues are presented net of related expenses. Expenses associated with financial advisory transactions are recorded asnon-compensationexpenses, net of client reimbursements.
 
Trading Assets and Trading Liabilities
 
Substantially all trading assets and trading liabilities are reflected in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value. Related gains or losses are generally recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value
 
In addition to trading assets, at fair value and trading liabilities, at fair value, the firm has elected to account for certain of its other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value under

9


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
ASC 815-15and 825-10(i.e., the fair value option). The primary reasons for electing the fair value option are to reflect economic events in earnings on a timely basis, to mitigate volatility in earnings from using different measurement attributes and to address simplification andcost-benefitconsiderations.
 
Such financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value include:
 
  • certain unsecuredshort-termborrowings, consisting of all promissory notes and commercial paper and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  • certain other secured financings, primarily transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales, debt raised through the firm’s William Street credit extension program and certain other nonrecourse financings;
 
  • certain unsecuredlong-termborrowings, including prepaid physical commodity transactions and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  • resale and repurchase agreements;
 
  • securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, consisting of the firm’s matched book and certain firm financing activities;
 
  • certain deposits issued by the firm’s bank subsidiaries, as well as securities held by Goldman Sachs Bank USA (GS Bank USA);
 
  • certain receivables from customers and counterparties, including certain margin loans, transfers of financial assets accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases and prepaid variable share forwards;
 
  • certain insurance and reinsurance contracts and certain guarantees;
 
  • certain subordinated liabilities issued by consolidated VIEs; and
 
  • in general, investments acquired after November 24, 2006, when the fair value option became available, where the firm has significant influence over the investee and would otherwise apply the equity method of accounting.
 
Fair Value Measurements
 
The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (i.e., the exit price). Financial assets are marked to bid prices and financial liabilities are marked to offer prices. Fair value measurements do not include transaction costs.
 
The fair value hierarchy under ASC 820 prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (level 1 measurements) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (level 3 measurements). The three levels of the fair value hierarchy are as follows:
 
Basis of Fair Value Measurement
 
  Level 1  Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets that are accessible at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities;

10


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
  Level 2  Quoted prices in markets that are not considered to be active or financial instruments for which all significant inputs are observable, either directly or indirectly;
 
  Level 3  Prices or valuations that require inputs that are both significant to the fair value measurement and unobservable.
 
A financial instrument’s level within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of any input that is significant to the fair value measurement. Transfers between levels are recognized at the beginning of the reporting period in which they occur.
 
The firm defines active markets for equity instruments based on the average daily trading volume both in absolute terms and relative to the market capitalization for the instrument. The firm defines active markets for debt instruments based on both the average daily trading volume and the number of days with trading activity.
 
Credit risk is an essential component of fair value. Cash products (e.g., bonds and loans) and derivative instruments (particularly those with significant future projected cash flows) trade in the market at levels which reflect credit considerations. The firm calculates the fair value of derivative assets by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates counterparty credit spreads and the fair value of derivative liabilities by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates the firm’s own credit spreads. In doing so, credit exposures are adjusted to reflect mitigants, namely collateral agreements which reduce exposures based on triggers and contractual posting requirements. The firm manages its exposure to credit risk as it does other market risks and will price, economically hedge, facilitate and intermediate trades which involve credit risk. The firm records liquidity valuation adjustments to reflect the cost of exiting concentrated risk positions, including exposure to the firm’s own credit spreads.
 
Trading Assets, at Fair Value and Trading Liabilities, at Fair Value
 
Level 1 and level 2 trading assets, at fair value and trading liabilities, at fair value.  In determining fair value, the firm separates trading assets, at fair value and trading liabilities, at fair value into two categories: cash instruments and derivative contracts.
 
The valuation techniques and significant inputs used in determining the fair values of cash instruments and derivative contracts classified within level 1 and level 2 of the fair value hierarchy are as follows:
 
  • Cash instruments.  The firm’s cash instruments are generally classified within level 1 or level 2 of the fair value hierarchy because they are valued using quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. The types of instruments valued based on quoted prices in active markets include U.S. andnon-U.S.government obligations, actively traded listed equities and certain money market instruments. These instruments are generally classified within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. Instruments classified within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy are required to be carried at quoted market prices, even in situations where the firm holds a large position and a sale could reasonably impact the quoted price.
 
The types of instruments that trade in markets that are not considered to be active, but are valued based on quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency include commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits, most government agency obligations, most corporate debt securities, certainmortgage-backedloans and securities, certain bank loans and bridge loans, less liquid publicly listed equities, certain state and municipal obligations and certain money market

11


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
instruments and loan commitments. These instruments are generally classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. For positions that are not traded in active markets or are subject to transfer restrictions, valuations are adjusted to reflect illiquidityand/ornon-transferability.Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available.
 
  • Derivative contracts.  Derivative contracts are instruments such as futures, forwards, swaps or option contracts that derive their value from underlying asset prices, indices, reference rates and other inputs or a combination of these factors. Derivative instruments may be privately negotiated contracts, which are often referred to asover-the-counter(OTC) derivatives, or they may be listed and traded on an exchange. The assets and inputs underlying derivative instruments may include financial instruments (such as government and corporate bonds, mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities and bank loans), currencies, commodities, interest rates and related indices.
 
Exchange-tradedderivatives typically fall within level 1 or level 2 of the fair value hierarchy depending on whether they are deemed to be actively traded or not. The firm generally valuesexchange-tradedderivatives using models which calibrate tomarket-clearinglevels and eliminate timing differences between the closing price of theexchange-tradedderivatives and their underlying instruments. In such cases,exchange-tradedderivatives are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
OTC derivatives are valued using market transactions and other market evidence whenever possible, includingmarket-basedinputs to models, calibration tomarket-clearingtransactions, broker or dealer quotations, or other alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Where models are used, the selection of a particular model to value an OTC derivative depends upon the contractual terms of, and specific risks inherent in, the instrument, as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. The firm generally uses similar models to value similar instruments. Valuation models require a variety of inputs, including contractual terms, market prices, yield curves, credit curves, measures of volatility, voluntary and involuntary prepayment rates, loss severity rates and correlations of such inputs. For OTC derivatives that trade in liquid markets, model inputs can generally be verified and model selection does not involve significant management judgment. OTC derivatives are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy when all of the significant inputs are corroborated by market evidence. When appropriate, valuations are adjusted for various factors such as liquidity, bid/offer spreads and credit considerations. Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available.
 
Level 3 trading assets, at fair value and trading liabilities, at fair value.  Absent evidence to the contrary, instruments classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are initially valued at transaction price, which is considered to be the best initial estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. Subsequent to the transaction date, the firm uses other methodologies to determine fair value, which vary based on the type of instrument, as described below. Regardless of methodology, valuation inputs and assumptions are only changed when corroborated by substantive evidence. Valuations are further corroborated by values realized upon sales of the firm’s level 3 assets. The valuation techniques and significant inputs used in determining the fair values of each class of cash instrument and derivative contracts classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are as follows:
 
  • Equities and convertible debentures.  For private equity investments, recentthird-partyinvestments or pending transactions are considered to be the best evidence for any change in

12


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 fair value. In the absence of such evidence, valuations are based on one or more of the following methodologies, as appropriate and available: transactions in similar instruments, discounted cash flow techniques,third-partyindependent appraisals, valuation multiples and public comparables. Such evidence includes pending reorganizations (e.g., merger proposals, tender offers or debt restructurings), and significant changes in financial metrics (e.g., operating results as compared to previous projections, industry multiples, credit ratings and balance sheet ratios). Real estate fund investments are carried at net asset value per share. The underlying investments in the funds are generally valued using discounted cash flow techniques, for which the significant inputs are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, capitalization rates and valuation multiples.
 
  • Bank loans and bridge loans, Corporate debt securities, State and municipal obligations and Other debt obligations.  Valuations are generally based on discounted cash flow techniques, for which the significant inputs are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, market yields and recovery assumptions. The significant inputs are generally determined based on relative value analyses, which incorporate comparisons both to credit default swaps that reference the same underlying credit risk and to other debt instruments for the same issuer for which observable prices or broker quotes are available.
 
  • Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate.  Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate are collateralized by specific assets and may be tranched into varying levels of subordination. Due to the nature of these instruments, valuation techniques vary by instrument, but are generally based on relative value analyses, discounted cash flow techniques or a combination thereof. Significant inputs for these valuations include transactions in both the underlying collateral and instruments with the same or substantially the same underlying collateral, credit default swap prices, current levels and trends of market indices (such as the CMBX), market yields and other factors (such as the operating income generated by the underlying collateral) which are used in determining the amount and timing of expected future cash flows.
 
  • Loans and securities backed by residential real estate.   Valuations are based on both proprietary and industry recognized models (including Intex and Bloomberg), and discounted cash flow techniques. The most significant inputs to the valuation of these instruments are the rates and timing of delinquencies, and default and loss expectations, which are driven in part by housing prices. The significant inputs are determined based on relative value analyses, which incorporate comparisons to instruments with similar collateral and risk profiles, including relevant indices such as the ABX.
 
  • Loan portfolios.  Loan portfolios are acquired portfolios of distressed loans, primarily backed by commercial and residential real estate collateral. Valuations are based on discounted cash flow techniques, for which the significant inputs are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows and market yields. The significant inputs are determined based on relative value analyses which incorporate comparisons to recent auction data for other similar loan portfolios.
 
  • Derivative contracts.  Certain OTC derivatives trade in less liquid markets with limited pricing information and the determination of fair value for these derivatives is inherently more difficult. The valuations of these less liquid OTC derivatives are typically based on level 1and/orlevel 2 inputs that can be observed in the market, as well as unobservable level 3 inputs. Unobservable inputs typically include certain correlations as well as credit spreads, equity volatilities, commodity prices and commodity volatilities that arelong-datedor derived from trading activity in inactive or less liquid markets. When unobservable inputs to a valuation

13


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 model are significant to the fair value measurement of an instrument, the instrument is classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Subsequent to initial recognition, the firm updates the level 1 and level 2 inputs to reflect observable market changes with resulting gains and losses reflected within level 3. Level 3 inputs are only changed when corroborated by evidence such as similar market transactions,third-partypricing servicesand/orbroker or dealer quotations, or other empirical market data. In circumstances where the firm cannot verify the model value to market transactions, it is possible that a different valuation model could produce a materially different estimate of fair value.
 
Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value
 
Other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value are generally valued based on discounted cash flow techniques which incorporate inputs with reasonable levels of price transparency and are generally classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Significant inputs for each category of other financial asset and financial liability at fair value are as follows:
 
  • Resale and Repurchase Agreements and Securities Borrowed and Loaned.  The significant inputs to the valuation of resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments (which are related to the firm’s matched book and certain firm financing activities) are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, interest rates and collateral funding spreads.
 
  • Other Secured Financings.  The significant inputs to the valuation of other secured financings at fair value, including transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales, debt raised through the firm’s William Street credit extension program and certain other nonrecourse financings, are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, interest rates, the fair value of the collateral delivered by the firm (which is determined using the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, market yields and recovery assumptions), the frequency of additional collateral calls and the credit spreads of the firm.
 
  • Unsecuredshort-termandlong-termborrowings.  The significant inputs to the valuation of certainshort-termandlong-termborrowings at fair value, including all promissory notes and commercial paper, certain hybrid financial instruments and prepaid physical commodity transactions, are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, interest rates, the credit spreads of the firm, as well as commodity prices in the case of prepaid physical commodity transactions and, for certain hybrid financial instruments, equity prices, inflation rates and index levels.
 
  • Receivables from customers and counterparties.  The significant inputs to the valuation of certain receivables from customers and counterparties, including certain margin loans, transfers of financial assets accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases and prepaid variable share forwards, are interest rates and the amount and timing of expected future cash flows.
 
  • Insurance and reinsurance contracts.  Insurance and reinsurance contracts at fair value are included in “Receivables from customers and counterparties” and “Other liabilities and accrued expenses” in the firm’s condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. These contracts are valued using market transactions and other market evidence where possible, includingmarket-basedinputs to models, calibration tomarket-clearingtransactions or other alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Significant level 2 inputs typically include interest rates and inflation risk. Significant level 3 inputs typically

14


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 include mortality or funding benefit assumptions. When unobservable inputs to a valuation model are significant to the fair value measurement of an instrument, the instrument is classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
  • Deposits.  The significant inputs to the valuation of deposits are interest rates.
 
Collateralized Agreements and Financings
 
Collateralized agreements consist of resale agreements and securities borrowed. For these agreements, the firm requires delivery of collateral with a fair value approximately equal to the carrying value of the relevant assets in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. Collateralized financings consist of repurchase agreements, securities loaned and other secured financings. Interest on collateralized agreements and collateralized financings is recognized in “Interest income” and “Interest expense,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings over the life of the transaction. Collateralized agreements and financings are presented on anet-by-counterpartybasis when a right of setoff exists.
 
  • Resale and Repurchase Agreements.  Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, principally U.S. government, federal agency andinvestment-gradesovereign obligations, represent collateralized financing transactions. The firm receives securities purchased under agreements to resell, makes delivery of securities sold under agreements to repurchase, monitors the market value of these securities on a daily basis and delivers or obtains additional collateral as appropriate. As noted above, resale and repurchase agreements are carried in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value under the fair value option.
 
  • Securities Borrowed and Loaned.  Securities borrowed and loaned are generally collateralized by cash, securities or letters of credit. The firm receives securities borrowed, makes delivery of securities loaned, monitors the market value of securities borrowed and loaned, and delivers or obtains additional collateral as appropriate. Securities borrowed and loaned within Securities Services, relating to both customer activities and, to a lesser extent, certain firm financing activities, are recorded based on the amount of cash collateral advanced or received plus accrued interest. As these arrangements generally can be terminated on demand, they exhibit little, if any, sensitivity to changes in interest rates. As noted above, securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, which are related to the firm’s matched book and certain firm financing activities, are recorded at fair value under the fair value option.
 
  • Other Secured Financings.  In addition to repurchase agreements and securities loaned, the firm funds assets through the use of other secured financing arrangements and pledges financial instruments and other assets as collateral in these transactions. As noted above, the firm has elected to apply the fair value option to transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales, debt raised through the firm’s William Street credit extension program and certain other nonrecourse financings, for which the use of fair value eliminatesnon-economicvolatility in earnings that would arise from using different measurement attributes. Other secured financings that are not recorded at fair value are recorded based on the amount of cash received plus accrued interest. See Note 3 for further information regarding other secured financings.

15


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
Hybrid Financial Instruments
 
Hybrid financial instruments are instruments that contain bifurcatable embedded derivatives and do not require settlement by physical delivery ofnon-financialassets (e.g., physical commodities). If the firm elects to bifurcate the embedded derivative from the associated debt, the derivative is accounted for at fair value and the host contract is accounted for at amortized cost, adjusted for the effective portion of any fair value hedge accounting relationships. If the firm does not elect to bifurcate, the entire hybrid financial instrument is accounted for at fair value under the fair value option. See Notes 3 and 6 for further information regarding hybrid financial instruments.
 
Transfers of Financial Assets
 
In general, transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when the firm has relinquished control over the transferred assets. For transfers of financial assets accounted for as sales, any related gains or losses are recognized in net revenues. Assets or liabilities that arise from the firm’s continuing involvement with transferred financial assets are measured at fair value. For transfers that are not accounted for as sales, the financial assets remain in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and the transfer is accounted for as a collateralized financing, with the related interest expense recognized in net revenues over the life of the transaction. When the firm transfers a security that has very little, if any, default risk under an agreement to repurchase the security where the maturity date of the repurchase agreement matches the maturity date of the underlying security (such that the firm effectively no longer has a repurchase obligation) and the firm has relinquished control over the underlying security, the firm records such transactions as sales. See“— RecentAccounting Developments” below for further information regarding accounting for transfers of financial assets.
 
Commissions
 
Commission revenues from executing and clearing client transactions on stock, options and futures markets are recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings on atrade-datebasis.
 
Insurance Activities
 
Certain of the firm’s insurance and reinsurance contracts are accounted for at fair value under the fair value option, with changes in fair value included in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Revenues from variable annuity and life insurance and reinsurance contracts not accounted for at fair value generally consist of fees assessed on contract holder account balances for mortality charges, policy administration fees and surrender charges, and are recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings in the period that services are provided.
 
Interest credited to variable annuity and life insurance and reinsurance contract account balances and changes in reserves are recognized in “Other expenses” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Premiums earned for underwriting property catastrophe reinsurance are recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings over the coverage period, net of premiums ceded for the cost of reinsurance. Expenses for liabilities related to property

16


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
catastrophe reinsurance claims, including estimates of losses that have been incurred but not reported, are recognized in “Other expenses” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Merchant Banking Overrides
 
The firm is entitled to receive merchant banking overrides (i.e., an increased share of a fund’s income and gains) when the return on the funds’ investments exceeds certain threshold returns. Overrides are based on investment performance over the life of each merchant banking fund, and future investment underperformance may require amounts of override previously distributed to the firm to be returned to the funds. Accordingly, overrides are recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings only when all material contingencies have been resolved. Overrides are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Asset Management
 
Management fees are recognized over the period that the related service is provided based upon average net asset values. In certain circumstances, the firm is also entitled to receive incentive fees based on a percentage of a fund’s return or when the return on assets under management exceeds specified benchmark returns or other performance targets. Incentive fees are generally based on investment performance over a12-monthperiod and are subject to adjustment prior to the end of the measurement period. Accordingly, incentive fees are recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings when the measurement period ends. Asset management fees and incentive fees are included in “Asset management and securities services” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Share-BasedCompensation
 
The cost of employee services received in exchange for ashare-basedaward is generally measured based on the grant-date fair value of the award in accordance with ASC 718.Share-basedawards that do not require future service (i.e., vested awards, including awards granted toretirement-eligibleemployees) are expensed immediately.Share-basedemployee awards that require future service are amortized over the relevant service period. Expected forfeitures are included in determiningshare-basedemployee compensation expense.
 
The firm pays cash dividend equivalents on outstanding restricted stock units (RSUs). Dividend equivalents paid on RSUs are generally charged to retained earnings. Dividend equivalents paid on RSUs expected to be forfeited are included in compensation expense. In the first quarter of fiscal 2009, the firm adopted amended accounting principles related to income tax benefits of dividends onshare-basedpayment awards (ASC 718). These amended principles require the tax benefit related to dividend equivalents paid on RSUs to be accounted for as an increase to additionalpaid-incapital. Previously, the firm accounted for this tax benefit as a reduction to income tax expense.
 
In certain cases, primarily related to the death of an employee or conflicted employment (as outlined in the applicable award agreements), the firm may cash settleshare-basedcompensation awards. For awards accounted for as equity instruments, additionalpaid-incapital is adjusted to the extent of the difference between the current value of the award and the grant-date value of the award.
 
Goodwill
 
Goodwill is the cost of acquired companies in excess of the fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition date. Goodwill is tested at least annually for impairment. An impairment loss is recognized

17


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
if the estimated fair value of an operating segment, which is a component one level below the firm’s three business segments, is less than its estimated net book value. Such loss is calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value of goodwill and its carrying value.
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
Identifiable intangible assets, which consist primarily of customer lists, television broadcast royalties, contractual rights related to commodity-related acquisitions, New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) Designated Market Maker (DMM) rights and the value of business acquired (VOBA) in the firm’s insurance subsidiaries, are amortized over their estimated lives or, in the case of insurance contracts, in proportion to estimated gross profits or premium revenues. Identifiable intangible assets are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable. An impairment loss, generally calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the sum of the estimated undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.
 
Property, Leasehold Improvements and Equipment
 
Property, leasehold improvements and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization, are recorded at cost and included in “Other assets” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
Substantially all property and equipment are depreciated on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the asset. Leasehold improvements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the improvement or the term of the lease, whichever is shorter. Certain costs of software developed or obtained for internal use are capitalized and amortized on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the software.
 
Property, leasehold improvements and equipment are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable. An impairment loss, calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the sum of the expected undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.
 
The firm’s operating leases include office space held in excess of current requirements. Rent expense relating to space held for growth is included in “Occupancy” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. The firm records a liability, based on the fair value of the remaining lease rentals reduced by any potential or existing sublease rentals, for leases where the firm has ceased using the space and management has concluded that the firm will not derive any future economic benefits. Costs to terminate a lease before the end of its term are recognized and measured at fair value upon termination.
 
Foreign Currency Translation
 
Assets and liabilities denominated innon-U.S. currenciesare translated at rates of exchange prevailing on the date of the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition, and revenues and expenses are translated at average rates of exchange for the period. Gains or losses on translation of the financial statements of anon-U.S. operation,when the functional currency is other than the U.S. dollar, are included, net of hedges and taxes, in the condensed consolidated statements

18


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
of comprehensive income. Foreign currency remeasurement gains or losses on transactions in nonfunctional currencies are included in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Hedge Accounting
 
The firm applies hedge accounting for certain derivative contracts used to manage the interest rate exposure of certain fixed-rate obligations, and for certain derivative contracts and foreigncurrency-denominateddebt used to manage foreign currency exposures resulting from the firm’s net investment in certainnon-U.S. operations.The firm documents its risk management strategy at the inception of each hedging relationship and assesses the effectiveness of each hedging relationship at least quarterly.
 
Fair Value Hedges — Interest Rate.  The firm designates certain interest rate swap contracts as fair value hedges. These interest rate swap contracts hedge changes in the relevant benchmark interest rate (e.g., London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR)), effectively converting a substantial portion of the firm’s unsecuredlong-termfixed-rate borrowings, certain unsecuredshort-termfixed-rateborrowings and certificates of deposit into floating rate obligations.
 
The firm applies the“long-haulmethod” in assessing the effectiveness of its fair value hedging relationships in achieving offsetting changes in the fair values of the hedging instrument and hedged item. During the three months ended March 2010, the firm changed its method of prospectively and retrospectively assessing the effectiveness of all of its fair value hedging relationships from adollar-offsetmethod, which is anon-statisticalmethod, to regression analysis, which is a statistical method. An interest rate swap is considered highly effective in offsetting changes in fair value attributable to changes in the hedged risk when the regression analysis results in a coefficient of determination of 80% or greater and a slope between 80% and 125%. Thedollar-offsetmethod compared the change in the fair value of the hedging instrument to the change in the fair value of the hedged item, excluding the effect of the passage of time. The firm’s prospectivedollar-offsetassessment utilized scenario analyses to test hedge effectiveness via simulations of numerous parallel and slope shifts of the relevant yield curve. Parallel shifts changed the interest rate of all maturities by identical amounts. Slope shifts changed the curvature of the yield curve. For both the prospective assessment, in response to each of the simulated yield curve shifts, and the retrospective assessment, a hedging relationship was deemed to be effective if the fair value of the hedging instrument and the hedged item changed inversely within a range of 80% to 125%.
 
For qualifying fair value hedges, gains or losses on derivative transactions are recognized in “Interest expense” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. The change in fair value of the hedged item attributable to the risk being hedged is reported as an adjustment to its carrying value and is subsequently amortized into interest expense over its remaining life. Gains or losses resulting from hedge ineffectiveness are included in “Interest expense” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Net Investment Hedges.  The firm seeks to reduce the impact of fluctuations in foreign exchange rates on its net investment in certainnon-U.S. operationsthrough the use of foreign currency forward contracts and foreigncurrency-denominateddebt. For foreign currency forward contracts designated as hedges, the effectiveness of the hedge is assessed based on the overall changes in the fair value of the forward contracts (that is, based on changes in forward rates). For foreigncurrency-denominateddebt designated as a hedge, the effectiveness of the hedge is assessed based on changes in spot rates. For qualifying net investment hedges, the gains or losses on hedging instruments, to the extent effective, are included in the condensed consolidated statements of comprehensive income.

19


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Income Taxes
 
Income taxes are provided for using the asset and liability method. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of the firm’s assets and liabilities. Valuation allowances are established to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount that more likely than not will be realized. The firm’s tax assets and liabilities are presented as a component of “Other assets” and “Other liabilities and accrued expenses,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. The firm recognizes tax positions in the financial statements only when it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained upon examination by the relevant taxing authority based on the technical merits of the position. A position that meets this standard is measured at the largest amount of benefit that will more likely than not be realized upon settlement. A liability is established for differences between positions taken in a tax return and amounts recognized in the financial statements. The firm reports interest expense related to income tax matters in “Provision for taxes” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings and income tax penalties in “Other expenses” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Earnings Per Common Share (EPS)
 
Basic EPS is calculated by dividing net earnings applicable to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding. Common shares outstanding includes common stock and RSUs for which no future service is required as a condition to the delivery of the underlying common stock. Diluted EPS includes the determinants of basic EPS and, in addition, reflects the dilutive effect of the common stock deliverable pursuant to stock warrants and options and to RSUs for which future service is required as a condition to the delivery of the underlying common stock. In the first quarter of fiscal 2009, the firm adopted amended accounting principles related to determining whether instruments granted inshare-basedpayment transactions are participating securities. Accordingly, the firm treats unvestedshare-basedpayment awards that havenon-forfeitablerights to dividends or dividend equivalents as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per common share.
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
The firm defines cash equivalents as highly liquid overnight deposits held in the ordinary course of business. As of March 2010 and December 2009, “Cash and cash equivalents” on the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition included $2.62 billion and $4.45 billion, respectively, of cash and due from banks and $24.44 billion and $33.84 billion, respectively, of interest-bearing deposits with banks.

20


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
Recent Accounting Developments
 
Transfers of Financial Assets and Interests in Variable Interest Entities (ASC 860 and 810).  In June 2009, the FASB issued amended accounting principles that changed the accounting for securitizations and VIEs. These principles were codified as ASUNo. 2009-16,“Transfers and Servicing (Topic 860) — Accounting for Transfers of Financial Assets” and ASUNo. 2009-17,“Consolidations (Topic 810) — Improvements to Financial Reporting by Enterprises Involved with Variable Interest Entities” in December 2009. ASUNo. 2009-16eliminates the concept of a qualifyingspecial-purposeentity (QSPE), changes the requirements for derecognizing financial assets, and requires additional disclosures about transfers of financial assets, including securitization transactions and continuing involvement with transferred financial assets. ASUNo. 2009-17changes the accounting and requires additional disclosures for VIEs. Under ASUNo. 2009-17,the determination of whether to consolidate a VIE is based on the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance together with either the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that could be significant to the VIE, as well as the VIE’s purpose and design. Additionally, entities previously classified as QSPEs are now required to be evaluated for consolidation and disclosure as VIEs. Previously, QSPEs were not consolidated and not considered for disclosure as VIEs and the determination of whether to consolidate a VIE was based on whether an enterprise had a variable interest, or combination of variable interests, that would absorb a majority of the VIE’s expected losses, receive a majority of the VIE’s expected residual returns, or both. ASU Nos.2009-16 and2009-17 were effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2009. In February 2010, the FASB issued ASUNo. 2010-10,“Consolidations (Topic 810) — Amendments For Certain Investment Funds,” which defers the requirements of ASUNo. 2009-17for certain interests in investment funds and certain similar entities.
 
The firm adopted ASU Nos.2009-16 and2009-17 as of January 1, 2010 and reassessed whether it was the primary beneficiary of any VIEs in which it had variable interests (including VIEs that were formerly QSPEs) as of that date. Adoption resulted in an increase to the firm’s total assets of approximately $3 billion as of March 2010, principally within “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition. In addition, “Other assets” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition increased by $545 million as of March 2010, with a corresponding decrease in “Trading assets, at fair value,” as a result of the consolidation of an entity which holds intangible assets. Upon adoption, the firm elected the fair value option for all eligible assets and liabilities of newly consolidated VIEs, except for (i) those VIEs where the financial assets and financial liabilities are accounted for either at fair value or in a manner that approximates fair value under other GAAP and (ii) those VIEs where the election would have caused volatility in earnings as a result of using different measurement attributes for financial instruments and nonfinancial assets. Adoption did not have a material impact on the firm’s results of operations or cash flows.
 
Improving Disclosures about Fair Value Measurements (ASC 820).  In January 2010, the FASB issued ASUNo. 2010-06,“Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures (Topic 820) — Improving Disclosures about Fair Value Measurements.” ASUNo. 2010-06provides amended disclosure requirements related to fair value measurements. Certain disclosure requirements of ASUNo. 2010-06were effective for the firm beginning in the first quarter of 2010, while other disclosure requirements of the ASU are effective for financial statements issued for reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2010. Since these amended principles require only additional disclosures concerning fair value measurements, adoption did not and will not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

21


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 3.  Financial Instruments
 
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s trading assets, at fair value, including those pledged as collateral, and trading liabilities, at fair value. At any point in time, the firm may use cash instruments as well as derivatives to manage a long or short risk position.
 
                 
  As of
  March 2010 December 2009
  Assets Liabilities Assets Liabilities
  (in millions)
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
 $11,735 (1) $  $9,111 (1) $ 
U.S. government and federal agency obligations
  79,451   20,426   78,336   20,982 
Non-U.S. governmentobligations
  43,030   29,929   38,858   23,843 
Mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities:
                
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
  6,241   39   6,203   29 
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
  5,657   9   6,704   74 
Loan portfolios
  1,338 (2)     1,370 (2)   
Bank loans and bridge loans
  20,787   2,158 (5)  19,345   1,541 (5)
Corporate debt securities
  25,653   7,224   26,368   6,229 
State and municipal obligations
  2,942   6   2,759   36 
Other debt obligations
  2,919      2,914    
Equities and convertible debentures
  65,348   26,392   71,474   20,253 
Physical commodities
  3,761   37   3,707   23 
Derivative contracts
  70,573 (3)  53,861 (6)  75,253 (3)  56,009 (6)
                 
Total
 $339,435 (4) $140,081  $342,402 (4) $129,019 
                 
 
 
  (1) Includes $4.03 billion and $4.31 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, of money market instruments held by William Street Funding Corporation (Funding Corp.) to support the William Street credit extension program. See Note 8 for further information regarding the William Street credit extension program.
 
  (2) Consists of acquired portfolios of distressed loans, primarily backed by commercial and residential real estate collateral.
 
  (3) Net of cash received pursuant to credit support agreements of $118.75 billion and $124.60 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (4) Includes $3.92 billion and $3.86 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, of securities accounted for asavailable-for-sale,substantially all of which is held within the firm’s insurance subsidiaries.
 
  (5) Includes the fair value of unfunded commitments to extend credit. The fair value of partially funded commitments is included in trading assets, at fair value.
 
  (6) Net of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements of $14.50 billion and $14.74 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.

22


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Fair Value Hierarchy
 
The firm’s financial assets at fair value classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are summarized below:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  ($ in millions)
Total level 3 assets
 $45,153  $46,475 
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure (1)
  42,513   43,348 
         
Total assets
  880,528   848,942 
Total financial assets at fair value
  606,238   573,788 
         
Total level 3 assets as a percentage of Total assets
  5.1%  5.5%
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure as a percentage of Total assets
  4.8   5.1 
         
Total level 3 assets as a percentage of Total financial assets at
fair value
  7.4   8.1 
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure as a percentage of Total financial assets at fair value
  7.0   7.6 
 
 
  (1) Excludes assets which are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.
 
The following tables set forth by level within the fair value hierarchy trading assets, at fair value, trading liabilities, at fair value, and other financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value under the fair value option as of March 2010 and December 2009. See Note 2 for further information on the fair value hierarchy. Assets and liabilities are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement.

23


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
                     
  Financial Assets at Fair Value as of March 2010
        Netting and
  
  Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Collateral Total
  (in millions)
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
 $4,345  $7,390  $  $  $11,735 
U.S. government and federal agency obligations
  30,536   48,915         79,451 
Non-U.S. governmentobligations
  39,043   3,987         43,030 
Mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities (1):
                    
Loans and securities backed by commercial
real estate
     2,171   4,070      6,241 
Loans and securities backed by residential
real estate
     3,526   2,131      5,657 
Loan portfolios
     47   1,291      1,338 
Bank loans and bridge loans
     11,464   9,323      20,787 
Corporate debt securities (2)
  116   22,834   2,703      25,653 
State and municipal obligations
     2,072   870      2,942 
Other debt obligations
     1,432   1,487      2,919 
Equities and convertible debentures
  32,700 (4)  21,995 (6)  10,653 (8)     65,348 
Physical commodities
     3,761         3,761 
                     
Cash instruments
  106,740   129,594   32,528      268,862 
Derivative contracts
  115   179,307   12,123   (120,972(9)  70,573 
                     
Trading assets, at fair value
  106,855   308,901   44,651   (120,972)  339,435 
Securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes
  17,975 (5)  9,337 (7)        27,312 
Securities purchased under agreements to resell
     166,100   268      166,368 
Securities borrowed
     71,349         71,349 
Receivables from customers and counterparties
     1,540   234      1,774 
                     
Total financial assets at fair value
 $124,830  $557,227  $45,153  $(120,972) $606,238 
                     
Level 3 assets for which the firm does not bear economic exposure (3)
          (2,640)        
                     
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure
         $42,513         
                     
 
 
(1)  Includes $141 million and $491 million of collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) backed by real estate within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy.
 
(2)  Includes $376 million and $802 million of CDOs and collateralized loan obligations (CLOs) backed by corporate obligations within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy.
 
(3)  Consists of level 3 assets which are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.
 
(4)  Consists of publicly listed equity securities.
 
(5)  Principally consists of U.S. Department of the Treasury (U.S. Treasury) securities and money market instruments as well as insurance separate account assets measured at fair value.
 
(6)  Substantially all consists of less liquid publicly listed securities.
 
(7)  Principally consists of securities borrowed and resale agreements. The underlying securities have been segregated to satisfy certain regulatory requirements.
 
(8)  Includes $9.45 billion of private equity investments, $968 million of real estate investments and $233 million of convertible debentures.
 
(9)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.
 

24


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
                     
  Financial Liabilities at Fair Value as of March 2010
        Netting and
  
  Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Collateral Total
  (in millions)
U.S. government and federal agency obligations
 $20,249  $177  $  $  $20,426 
Non-U.S. governmentobligations
  29,621   308         29,929 
Mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities:
                    
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
     39         39 
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
     9         9 
Bank loans and bridge loans
     1,751   407      2,158 
Corporate debt securities (1)
  31   7,122   71      7,224 
State and municipal obligations
     6         6 
Equities and convertible debentures (2)
  25,047   1,340   5      26,392 
Physical commodities
     37         37 
                     
Cash instruments
  74,948   10,789   483      86,220 
Derivative contracts
  136   64,657   5,787   (16,719(4)  53,861 
                     
Trading liabilities, at fair value
  75,084   75,446   6,270   (16,719)  140,081 
Deposits
     2,014         2,014 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase,
at fair value
     152,462   1,055      153,517 
Securities loaned
     3,108         3,108 
Other secured financings
  178   7,669   8,139      15,986 
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings
     16,600   2,994      19,594 
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings
     18,472   1,715      20,187 
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
     455   2,327      2,782 
                     
Total financial liabilities at fair value
 $75,262  $276,226  $22,500 (3) $(16,719) $357,269 
                     
 
 
(1)  Includes $5 million and $45 million of CDOs and CLOs backed by corporate obligations within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy.
 
(2)  Substantially all consists of publicly listed equity securities.
 
(3)  Level 3 liabilities were 6.3% of Total financial liabilities at fair value.
 
(4)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.

25


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
                     
  Financial Assets at Fair Value as of December 2009
        Netting and
  
  Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Collateral Total
  (in millions)
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
 $5,026  $4,085  $  $  $9,111 
U.S. government and federal agency obligations
  36,391   41,945         78,336 
Non-U.S. governmentobligations
  33,881   4,977         38,858 
Mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities (1):
                    
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
     1,583   4,620      6,203 
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
     4,824   1,880      6,704 
Loan portfolios
     6   1,364      1,370 
Bank loans and bridge loans
     9,785   9,560      19,345 
Corporate debt securities (2)
  164   23,969   2,235      26,368 
State and municipal obligations
     1,645   1,114      2,759 
Other debt obligations
     679   2,235      2,914 
Equities and convertible debentures
  37,103 (4)  22,500 (6)  11,871  (9)     71,474 
Physical commodities
     3,707         3,707 
                     
Cash instruments
  112,565   119,705   34,879      267,149 
Derivative contracts
  161   190,816 (7)  11,596  (7)  (127,320(10)  75,253 
                     
Trading assets, at fair value
  112,726   310,521   46,475   (127,320)  342,402 
Securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes
  14,381 (5)  4,472 (8)        18,853 
Securities purchased under agreements to resell
     144,279         144,279 
Securities borrowed
     66,329         66,329 
Receivables from customers and counterparties
     1,925         1,925 
                     
Total financial assets at fair value
 $127,107  $527,526  $46,475  $(127,320) $573,788 
                     
Level 3 assets for which the firm does not bear economic exposure (3)
          (3,127)        
                     
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure
         $43,348         
                     
 
 
  (1) Includes $291 million and $311 million of CDOs and CLOs backed by real estate within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy.
 
  (2) Includes $338 million and $741 million of CDOs and CLOs backed by corporate obligations within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy.
 
  (3) Consists of level 3 assets which are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.
 
  (4) Consists of publicly listed equity securities.
 
  (5) Principally consists of U.S. Treasury securities and money market instruments as well as insurance separate account assets measured at fair value.
 
  (6) Substantially all consists of less liquid publicly listed securities.
 
  (7) Includes $31.44 billion and $9.58 billion of credit derivative assets within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy. These amounts exclude the effects of netting under enforceable netting agreements across other derivative product types.
 
  (8) Principally consists of securities borrowed and resale agreements. The underlying securities have been segregated to satisfy certain regulatory requirements.
 
  (9) Includes $10.56 billion of private equity investments, $1.23 billion of real estate investments and $79 million of convertible debentures.
 
(10) Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.
 

26


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
                     
  Financial Liabilities at Fair Value as of December 2009
        Netting and
  
  Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Collateral Total
  (in millions)
U.S. government and federal agency obligations
 $20,940  $42  $  $  $20,982 
Non-U.S. governmentobligations
  23,306   537         23,843 
Mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities:
                    
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
     29         29 
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
     74         74 
Bank loans and bridge loans
     1,128   413      1,541 
Corporate debt securities (1)
  65   6,018   146      6,229 
State and municipal obligations
     36         36 
Equities and convertible debentures (2)
  19,072   1,168   13      20,253 
Physical commodities
     23         23 
                     
Cash instruments
  63,383   9,055   572      73,010 
Derivative contracts
  126   66,943 (3)  6,400 (3)  (17,460(5)  56,009 
                     
Trading liabilities, at fair value
  63,509   75,998   6,972   (17,460)  129,019 
Deposits
     1,947         1,947 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
     127,966   394      128,360 
Securities loaned
     6,194         6,194 
Other secured financings
  118   8,354   6,756      15,228 
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings
     16,093   2,310      18,403 
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings
     18,315   3,077      21,392 
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
     141   1,913      2,054 
                     
Total financial liabilities at fair value
 $63,627  $255,008  $21,422 (4) $(17,460) $322,597 
                     
 
 
(1)  Includes $45 million of CDOs and CLOs backed by corporate obligations within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
(2)  Substantially all consists of publicly listed equity securities.
 
(3)  Includes $7.96 billion and $3.20 billion of credit derivative liabilities within level 2 and level 3, respectively, of the fair value hierarchy. These amounts exclude the effects of netting under enforceable netting agreements across other derivative product types.
 
(4)  Level 3 liabilities were 6.6% of Total financial liabilities at fair value.
 
(5)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.

27


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The fair value of the firm’s derivative contracts is reflected net of cash paid or received pursuant to credit support agreements and is reported on anet-by-counterpartybasis in the firm’s consolidated statements of financial condition when management believes a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement. The following table sets forth the fair value of the firm’s derivative contracts on a gross basis by level within the fair value hierarchy and major product type as of March 2010. Gross fair values in the tables below exclude the effects of both netting under enforceable netting agreements and netting of cash received or posted pursuant to credit support agreements both within and across the levels of the fair value hierarchy, and therefore are not representative of the firm’s exposure.
 
                     
  Derivative Assets at Fair Value as of March 2010
        Cross-Level
  
  Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Netting Total
  (in millions)
Interest rates
 $45  $481,042  $506      $481,593 
Credit
     136,888   13,344       150,232 
Currencies
     72,080   667       72,747 
Commodities
     42,617   761       43,378 
Equities
  70   62,965   1,467       64,502 
                     
Gross fair value of derivative assets
 $115  $795,592  $16,745      $812,452 
Counterparty netting (1)
     (616,285)  (4,622) $(2,218(3)  (623,125)
                     
Subtotal
 $115  $179,307  $12,123  $(2,218) $189,327 
Cash collateral netting (2)
                  (118,754)
                     
Fair value included in trading
assets, at fair value
                 $70,573 
                     
                     
                     
  Derivative Liabilities at Fair Value as of March 2010
        Cross-Level
  
  Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Netting Total
  (in millions)
Interest rates
 $55  $413,419  $430      $413,904 
Credit
     115,392   6,162       121,554 
Currencies
     59,339   195       59,534 
Commodities
     44,749   1,009       45,758 
Equities
  81   48,043   2,613       50,737 
                     
Gross fair value of derivative assets
 $136  $680,942  $10,409      $691,487 
Counterparty netting (1)
     (616,285)  (4,622) $(2,218(3)  (623,125)
                     
Subtotal
 $136  $64,657  $5,787  $(2,218) $68,362 
Cash collateral netting (2)
                  (14,501)
                     
Fair value included in trading
liabilities, at fair value
                 $53,861 
                     
 
 
  (1) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty pursuant to enforceable netting agreements.
 
  (2) Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
  (3) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across levels of the fair value hierarchy pursuant to enforceable netting agreements.

28


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Level 3 Unrealized Gains/(Losses)
 
The table below sets forth a summary of unrealized gains/(losses) on the firm’s level 3 financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value still held at the reporting date for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009:
 
         
  Level 3 Unrealized
  Gains/(Losses)
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Cash instruments — assets
 $833  $(4,072)
Cash instruments — liabilities
  34   15 
         
Net unrealized gains/(losses) on level 3 cash instruments
  867   (4,057)
Derivative contracts — net
  1,568   975 
Receivables from customers and counterparties
  (28)   
Other secured financings
  (10)  17 
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings
  82   124 
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings
  12   82 
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
  64   64 
         
Total level 3 unrealized gains/(losses)
 $2,555  $(2,795)
         
 
Cash Instruments
 
The net unrealized gain on level 3 cash instruments of $867 million for the three months ended March 2010 primarily consisted of unrealized gains on corporate debt securities, bank loans and bridge loans, loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, and loans and securities backed by residential real estate reflecting a decrease in market yields evidenced by sales of similar assets during the period. The net unrealized loss on level 3 cash instruments of $4.06 billion for the three months ended March 2009 primarily consisted of unrealized losses on private equity investments and real estate fund investments, loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, and bank loans and bridge loans. Losses during the period reflected the weakness in the global credit and equity markets.
 
Level 3 cash instruments are frequently economically hedged with instruments classified within level 1 and level 2, and accordingly, gains or losses that have been reported in level 3 can be partially offset by gains or losses attributable to instruments classified within level 1 or level 2 or by gains or losses on derivative contracts classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

29


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Derivative Contracts
 
The net unrealized gain on level 3 derivative contracts of $1.57 billion for the three months ended March 2010 was primarily attributable to changes in foreign exchange rates and interest rates (which are level 2 inputs) underlying certain credit derivative contracts. These unrealized gains were substantially offset by unrealized losses on currency, interest rate and credit derivative contracts which are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy and are used to economically hedge derivative contracts classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The net unrealized gain on level 3 derivative contracts of $975 million for the three months ended March 2009 was primarily attributable to increases in commodities prices (which are level 2 inputs) and changes in credit spreads corroborated by trading activity during the quarter. Level 3 gains and losses on derivative contracts should be considered in the context of the following:
 
  • A derivative contract with level 1and/orlevel 2 inputs is classified as a level 3 financial instrument in its entirety if it has at least one significant level 3 input.
 
  • If there is one significant level 3 input, the entire gain or loss from adjusting only observable inputs (i.e., level 1 and level 2) is still classified as level 3.
 
  • Gains or losses that have been reported in level 3 resulting from changes in level 1 or level 2 inputs are frequently offset by gains or losses attributable to instruments classified within level 1 or level 2 or cash instruments reported within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

30


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
The tables below set forth a summary of changes in the fair value of the firm’s level 3 financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009. The tables reflect gains and losses, including gains and losses for the entire period on financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value that were transferred to level 3 during the period, for all financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value categorized as level 3 as of March 2010 and March 2009, respectively.
 
                         
  Level 3 Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value
      Net unrealized
      
      gains/(losses)
 Net
    
      relating to
 purchases,
    
  Balance,
   instruments still
 issuances
 Net transfers
 Balance,
  beginning
 Net realized
 held at the
 and
 in and/orout
 end of
  of year gains/(losses) reporting date settlements of level 3 period
  (in millions)
Three Months Ended March 2010
                        
Mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities:
                        
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
 $4,620  $63  $184  $(506) $(291(4) $4,070 
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
  1,880   37   102   (141)  253  (4)  2,131 
Loan portfolios
  1,364   28   3   (116)  12  (4)  1,291 
Bank loans and bridge loans
  9,560   180   202   (655)  36  (4)  9,323 
Corporate debt securities
  2,235   82   260   707   (581(5)  2,703 
State and municipal obligations
  1,114   1   5   (225)  (25(4)  870 
Other debt obligations
  2,235   (5)  94   (75)  (762(6)  1,487 
Equities and convertible debentures
  11,871   115   (17)  (1,053)  (263(4)  10,653 
                         
Total cash instruments — assets
  34,879   501  (1)  833  (1)  (2,064)  (1,621)  32,528 
                         
Cash instruments — liabilities
  (572)  14  (2)  34  (2)  10   31  (4)  (483)
Derivative contracts:
                        
Interest rates — net
  (71)  9   (43)  (1)  200  (4)  94 
Credit — net
  6,366   332   1,459   (755)  (265(4)  7,137 
Currencies — net
  215   (18)  5   9   257  (4)  468 
Commodities — net
  (90)  6   71   3   (234(4)  (244)
Equities — net
  (1,224)  40   76   (173)  162  (4)  (1,119)
                         
Total derivative contracts — net
  5,196   369  (2)  1,568  (2)(3)  (917)  120   6,336 
                         
Securities purchased under agreements to resell
                268  (4)  268 
Receivables from customers and counterparties
     6  (2)  (28(2)     256  (4)  234 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
  (394)          (494)  (167(4)  (1,055)
Other secured financings
  (6,756)  (9(2)  (10(2)  (1,172)  (192(7)  (8,139)
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings
  (2,310)  (21(2)  82  (2)  139   (884(7)  (2,994)
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings
  (3,077)  (13(2)  12  (2)  (33)  1,396  (8)  (1,715)
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
  (1,913)  (3(2)  64  (2)     (475(9)  (2,327)
 
 
(1)  The aggregate amounts include approximately $961 million and $373 million reported in “Trading and principal investments” and “Interest income,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings for the three months ended March 2010.
(2)  Substantially all is reported in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
(3)  Principally resulted from changes in level 2 inputs.
(4)  Includes no individually significant transfers into or out of level 3 during the three months ended March 2010.
(5)  Principally reflects a reduction in financial instruments as a result of the consolidation of a VIE, which holds identifiable intangible assets, as a result of the adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17.Such assets are included in “Other assets” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.
(6)  Principally reflects a reduction in financial instruments as a result of the consolidation of a VIE, which holds real estate assets. Such assets are included in “Other assets” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.
(7)  Principally reflects consolidation of certain VIEs as a result of the adoption of ASU No. 2009-17.
(8)  Upon the firm’s consolidation of certain VIEs as a result of the adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17,the firm’s borrowings from such VIEs, substantially all of which were level 3, became intercompany borrowings and were eliminated in consolidation.
(9)  Principally reflects an increase related to subordinated liabilities issued by VIEs which were consolidated upon the adoption of ASU No. 2009-17.

31


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
                         
  Level 3 Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value
      Net unrealized
      
      gains/(losses)
 Net
    
      relating to
 purchases,
    
  Balance,
   instruments still
 issuances
 Net transfers
 Balance,
  beginning
 Net realized
 held at the
 and
 in and/orout
 end of
  of period gains/(losses) reporting date settlements of level 3 period
  (in millions)
Three Months Ended March 2009
                        
                         
Cash instruments — assets
 $49,652  $623  (1) $(4,072(1) $(2,462) $(1,057(4) $42,684 
Cash instruments — liabilities
  (1,727)  14  (2)  15  (2)  285   109   (1,304)
Derivative contracts — net
  3,315   238  (2)  975  (2)(3)  342   (754(5)  4,116 
Other secured financings
  (4,039)  (6(2)  17  (2)  (1,144)  (2,105(6)  (7,277)
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings
  (4,712)  32  (2)  124  (2)  (868)  2,281  (6)  (3,143)
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings
  (1,689)  (13(2)  82  (2)  177   (473(6)  (1,916)
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
     (10(2)  64  (2)  (600)  (964(7)  (1,510)
 
 
(1)  The aggregate amounts include approximately $(4.07) billion and $620 million reported in “Trading and principal investments” and “Interest income,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings for the three months ended March 2009.
 
(2)  Substantially all is reported in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings.
 
(3)  Principally resulted from changes in level 2 inputs and changes in credit spreads corroborated by trading activity during the period.
 
(4)  Principally reflects the deconsolidation of certain loan portfolios for which the firm did not bear economic exposure.
 
(5)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of certain derivative liabilities, due to reduced trading activity, and therefore price transparency, on the underlying instruments.
 
(6)  Principally reflects transfers from level 3 unsecuredshort-termborrowings to level 3 other secured financings and level 3 unsecuredlong-termborrowings related to changes in the terms of certain notes.
 
(7)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of certain insurance contracts, reflecting reduced transparency of mortality curve inputs used to value these instruments as a result of less observable trading activity.

32


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Derivative Activities
 
Derivative contracts are instruments such as futures, forwards, swaps or option contracts that derive their value from underlying asset prices, indices, reference rates and other inputs or a combination of these factors. Derivative instruments may be privately negotiated contracts, which are often referred to as OTC derivatives, or they may be listed and traded on an exchange. Derivatives may involve future commitments to purchase or sell financial instruments or commodities, or to exchange currency or interest payment streams. The amounts exchanged are based on the specific terms of the contract with reference to specified rates, financial instruments, commodities, currencies or indices.
 
Certain cash instruments such asmortgage-backedsecurities, interest-only and principal-only obligations, and indexed debt instruments are not considered derivatives even though their values or contractually required cash flows are derived from the price of some other security or index. However, certain commodity-related contracts are included in the firm’s derivatives disclosure, as these contracts may be settled in cash or the assets to be delivered under the contract are readily convertible into cash.
 
The firm enters into derivative transactions to facilitate client transactions, as a means of risk management or to take proprietary positions. Risk exposures are managed through diversification, by controlling position sizes and by entering into offsetting positions. For example, the firm may manage the risk related to a portfolio of common stock by entering into an offsetting position in a relatedequity-indexfutures contract.
 
Gains and losses on derivatives used for trading purposes are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. See Note 2 for information regarding the firm’s accounting policy and use of derivatives for hedge accounting.

33


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The fair value of the firm’s derivative contracts is reflected net of cash paid or received pursuant to credit support agreements and is reported on anet-by-counterpartybasis in the firm’s condensed consolidated statements of financial condition when management believes a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement. The following table sets forth the fair value and the number of contracts of the firm’s derivative contracts by major product type on a gross basis as of March 2010 and December 2009. Gross fair values in the table below exclude the effects of both netting under enforceable netting agreements and netting of cash received or posted pursuant to credit support agreements, and therefore are not representative of the firm’s exposure:
 
                         
  As of March 2010 As of December 2009
      Number
     Number
  Derivative
 Derivative
 of
 Derivative
 Derivative
 of
  Assets Liabilities Contracts Assets Liabilities Contracts
  (in millions, except number of contracts)
Derivative contracts for trading activities                        
Interest rates
 $460,870  $413,903   262,110  $458,614  $407,125   270,707 
Credit
  150,232   121,554   434,738   164,669   134,810   443,450 
Currencies
  72,734   59,447   233,634   77,223   62,413   171,760 
Commodities
  43,378   45,758   64,457   47,234   48,163   73,010 
Equities
  64,502   50,737   242,825   67,559   53,207   237,625 
                         
Subtotal
 $791,716  $691,399   1,237,764  $815,299  $705,718   1,196,552 
                         
Derivative contracts accounted for as hedges                        
Interest rates
 $20,723  $1   806  $19,563  $1   806 
Currencies
  13   87   63   8   47   58 
                         
Subtotal
 $20,736  $88   869  $19,571  $48   864 
                         
Gross fair value of derivative contracts
 $812,452  $691,487   1,238,633  $834,870  $705,766   1,197,416 
                         
Counterparty netting (1)
  (623,125)  (623,125)      (635,014)  (635,014)    
Cash collateral netting (2)
  (118,754)  (14,501)      (124,603)  (14,743)    
                         
Fair value included in trading assets,
at fair value
 $70,573          $75,253         
                         
Fair value included in trading liabilities,
at fair value
     $53,861          $56,009     
                         
 
 
(1)  Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty pursuant to enforceable netting agreements.
 
(2)  Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.

34


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
For the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, the gain/(loss) recognized on interest rate derivative contracts accounted for as hedges was $687 million and $(2.47) billion, respectively, and the related gain/(loss) recognized on the hedged borrowings and bank deposits was $(1.10) billion and $2.43 billion, respectively. These gains and losses are included in “Interest expense” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. The hedge ineffectiveness recognized on these derivative contracts for the three months ended March 2010 was a loss of $413 million. This loss consisted primarily of the amortization of prepaid credit spreads, and was not material for the three months ended March 2009. Thegain/(loss)excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness was not material for the three months ended March 2010 and was a loss of $316 million for the three months ended March 2009.
 
For the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, the gain on currency derivative contracts accounted for as hedges was $121 million and $153 million, respectively. Such amounts are included in “Currency translation adjustment, net of tax” in the condensed consolidated statements of comprehensive income. Thegain/(loss)related to ineffectiveness and thegain/(loss)reclassified to earnings from accumulated other comprehensive income were not material for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009.
 
The firm also has embedded derivatives that have been bifurcated from related borrowings. Such derivatives, which are classified in unsecuredshort-termand unsecuredlong-termborrowings in the firm’s condensed consolidated statements of financial condition, had a net asset carrying value of $95 million and $96 million as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. The net asset as of March 2010, which represented 306 contracts, included gross assets of $447 million (primarily comprised of equity and interest rate derivatives) and gross liabilities of $352 million (primarily comprised of interest rate and equity derivatives). The net asset as of December 2009, which represented 297 contracts, included gross assets of $478 million (primarily comprised of equity and interest rate derivatives) and gross liabilities of $382 million (primarily comprised of equity and interest rate derivatives). See Notes 6 and 7 for further information regarding the firm’s unsecured borrowings.
 
As of March 2010 and December 2009, the firm has designated $3.37 billion and $3.38 billion, respectively, of foreigncurrency-denominateddebt, included in unsecuredlong-termborrowings and unsecuredshort-termborrowings in the firm’s condensed consolidated statements of financial condition, as hedges of net investments innon-U.S. subsidiaries.For the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, the gain on these debt instruments was $12 million and $269 million, respectively. Such amounts are included in “Currency translation adjustment, net of tax” in the condensed consolidated statements of comprehensive income. The gain/(loss) related to ineffectiveness and the gain/(loss) reclassified to earnings from accumulated other comprehensive income was not material for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009.

35


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The following table sets forth by major product type the firm’s gains/(losses) related to trading activities, including both derivative and nonderivative financial instruments, for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009. These gains/(losses) are not representative of the firm’s individual business unit results because many of the firm’s trading strategies utilize financial instruments across various product types. Accordingly, gains or losses in one product type frequently offset gains or losses in other product types. For example, most of the firm’s longer-term derivative contracts are sensitive to changes in interest rates and may be economically hedged with interest rate swaps. Similarly, a significant portion of the firm’s cash and derivatives trading inventory has exposure to foreign currencies and may be economically hedged with foreign currency contracts. Thegains/(losses)set forth below are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings and exclude related interest income and interest expense.
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Interest rates
 $(1,914) $660 
Credit
  4,103   1,556 
Currencies (1)
  3,321   977 
Equities
  1,573   1,044 
Commodities and other
  818   1,769 
         
Total
 $7,901  $6,006 
         
 
 
  (1) Includes gains/(losses) on currency contracts used to economically hedge positions included in other product types in this table.
 
Certain of the firm’s derivative instruments have been transacted pursuant to bilateral agreements with certain counterparties that may require the firm to post collateral or terminate the transactions based on the firm’slong-termcredit ratings. As of March 2010, the aggregate fair value of such derivative contracts that were in a net liability position was $22.42 billion, and the aggregate fair value of assets posted by the firm as collateral for these derivative contracts was $14.80 billion. As of March 2010, additional collateral or termination payments pursuant to bilateral agreements with certain counterparties of approximately $1.51 billion and $2.77 billion could have been called by counterparties in the event of aone-notchandtwo-notchreduction, respectively, in the firm’slong-termcredit ratings. As of December 2009, the aggregate fair value of such derivative contracts that were in a net liability position was $20.85 billion, and the aggregate fair value of assets posted by the firm as collateral for these derivative contracts was $14.48 billion. As of December 2009, additional collateral or termination payments pursuant to bilateral agreements with certain counterparties of approximately $1.12 billion and $2.36 billion could have been called by counterparties in the event of aone-notchandtwo-notchreduction, respectively, in the firm’slong-termcredit ratings.

36


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The firm enters into a broad array of credit derivatives to facilitate client transactions, to take proprietary positions and as a means of risk management. The firm uses each of the credit derivatives described below for these purposes. These credit derivatives are entered into by various trading desks around the world, and are actively managed based on the underlying risks. These activities are frequently part of a broader trading strategy and are dynamically managed based on the net risk position. As individually negotiated contracts, credit derivatives can have numerous settlement and payment conventions. The more common types of triggers include bankruptcy of the reference credit entity, acceleration of indebtedness, failure to pay, restructuring, repudiation and dissolution of the entity.
 
  • Credit default swaps.  Single-name credit default swaps protect the buyer against the loss of principal on one or more bonds, loans or mortgages (reference obligations) in the event of a default by the issuer (reference entity). The buyer of protection pays an initial or periodic premium to the seller and receives credit default protection for the period of the contract. If there is no credit default event, as defined by the specific derivative contract, then the seller of protection makes no payments to the buyer of protection. However, if a credit default event occurs, the seller of protection will be required to make a payment to the buyer of protection. Typical credit default events requiring payment include bankruptcy of the reference credit entity, failure to pay the principal or interest, and restructuring of the relevant obligations of the reference entity.
 
  • Credit indices, baskets and tranches.  Credit derivatives may reference a basket of single-name credit default swaps or abroad-basedindex. Typically, in the event of a default of one of the underlying reference obligations, the protection seller will pay to the protection buyer a pro-rata portion of a transaction’s total notional amount relating to the underlying defaulted reference obligation. In tranched transactions, the credit risk of a basket or index is separated into various portions each having different levels of subordination. The most junior tranches cover initial defaults, and once losses exceed the notional amount of these tranches, the excess is covered by the next most senior tranche in the capital structure.
 
  • Total return swaps.  A total return swap transfers the risks relating to economic performance of a reference obligation from the protection buyer to the protection seller. Typically, the protection buyer receives from the protection seller a floating rate of interest and protection against any reduction in fair value of the reference obligation, and in return the protection seller receives the cash flows associated with the reference obligation, plus any increase in the fair value of the reference obligation.
 
  • Credit options.  In a credit option, the option writer assumes the obligation to purchase or sell a reference obligation at a specified price or credit spread. The option purchaser buys the right to sell the reference obligation to, or purchase it from, the option writer. The payments on credit options depend either on a particular credit spread or the price of the reference obligation.
 
Substantially all of the firm’s purchased credit derivative transactions are with financial institutions and are subject to stringent collateral thresholds. The firm economically hedges its exposure to written credit derivatives primarily by entering into offsetting purchased credit derivatives with identical underlyings. In addition, upon the occurrence of a specified trigger event, the firm may take possession of the reference obligations underlying a particular written credit derivative, and consequently may, upon liquidation of the reference obligations, recover amounts on the underlying reference obligations in the event of default. As of March 2010, the firm’s written and purchased credit derivatives had total gross notional amounts of $2.37 trillion and $2.53 trillion, respectively, for total net purchased protection of $161.61 billion in notional value. As of December 2009, the firm’s written and purchased credit derivatives had total gross notional amounts of $2.54 trillion and $2.71 trillion, respectively, for total net purchased protection of $164.13 billion in notional value.

37


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The following table sets forth certain information related to the firm’s credit derivatives. Fair values in the table below exclude the effects of both netting under enforceable netting agreements and netting of cash paid or received pursuant to credit support agreements, and therefore are not representative of the firm’s exposure.
 
                                     
    Maximum Payout/Notional
  
  Maximum Payout/Notional Amount
 Amount of Purchased
 Fair Value of
  of Written Credit Derivatives by Tenor (1) Credit Derivatives Written Credit Derivatives
          Offsetting
 Other
      
      5 Years
   Purchased
 Purchased
     Net
  0 - 12
 1 - 5
 or
   Credit
 Credit
     Asset/
  Months Years Greater Total Derivatives (2) Derivatives (3) Asset Liability (Liability)
  ($ in millions)
As of March 2010
                                    
Credit spread on underlying (basis points)(4)                                    
0-250
 $255,593  $1,270,269  $400,256  $1,926,118  $1,782,661  $290,037  $37,799  $19,761  $18,038 
251-500
  10,501   142,331   35,273   188,105   173,539   29,597   6,012   6,084   (72)
501-1,000
  12,556   102,082   37,144   151,782   125,875   19,350   4,034   10,550   (6,516)
Greater than 1,000
  10,061   72,873   23,481   106,415   77,648   35,323   2,073   44,628   (42,555)
                                     
Total
 $288,711  $1,587,555  $496,154  $2,372,420  $2,159,723  $374,307  $49,918  $81,023  $(31,105(5)
                                     
As of December 2009                                    
Credit spread on underlying (basis points)(4)                                    
0-250
 $283,353  $1,342,649  $414,809  $2,040,811  $1,884,864  $299,329  $39,740  $13,441  $26,299 
251-500
  15,151   142,732   39,337   197,220   182,583   27,194   5,008   6,816   (1,808)
501-1,000
  10,364   101,621   34,194   146,179   141,317   5,673   2,841   12,448   (9,607)
Greater than 1,000
  20,262   107,768   31,208   159,238   117,914   48,699   1,524   60,279   (58,755)
                                     
Total
 $329,130  $1,694,770  $519,548  $2,543,448  $2,326,678  $380,895  $49,113  $92,984  $(43,871(5)
                                     
 
 
(1)  Tenor is based on expected duration formortgage-relatedcredit derivatives and on remaining contractual maturity for other credit derivatives.
 
(2)  Offsetting purchased credit derivatives represent the notional amount of purchased credit derivatives to the extent they economically hedge written credit derivatives with identical underlyings.
 
(3)  Comprised of purchased protection in excess of the amount of written protection on identical underlyings and purchased protection on other underlyings on which the firm has not written protection.
 
(4)  Credit spread on the underlying, together with the tenor of the contract, are indicators of payment/performance risk. For example, the firm is least likely to pay or otherwise be required to perform where the credit spread on the underlying is“0-250”basis points and the tenor is“0-12 Months.”The likelihood of payment or performance is generally greater as the credit spread on the underlying and tenor increase.
 
(5)  These net liabilities differ from the carrying values related to credit derivatives in the firm’s condensed consolidated statements of financial condition because they exclude the effects of both netting under enforceable netting agreements and netting of cash collateral paid or received pursuant to credit support agreements.

38


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Impact of Credit Spreads
 
On an ongoing basis, the firm realizes gains or losses relating to changes in credit risk on derivative contracts through changes in credit mitigants or the sale or unwind of the contracts. The net gain attributable to the impact of changes in credit exposure and credit spreads on derivative contracts (including derivative assets and liabilities and related hedges) was $44 million and $48 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively.
 
The following table sets forth the net gains/(losses) attributable to the impact of changes in the firm’s own credit spreads on borrowings for which the fair value option was elected. The firm calculates the fair value of borrowings by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates the firm’s observable credit spreads.
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Net gains/(losses) including hedges
 $107  $(197)
Net gains/(losses) excluding hedges
  109   (192)
 
The net gain/(loss) attributable to changes in instrument-specific credit spreads on loans and loan commitments for which the fair value option was elected was $1.07 billion and $(1.21) billion for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively. The firm attributes changes in the fair value of floating rate loans and loan commitments to changes in instrument-specific credit spreads. For fixed rate loans and loan commitments, the firm allocates changes in fair value between interest rate-related changes and credit spread-related changes based on changes in interest rates. See below for additional details regarding the fair value option.

39


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The Fair Value Option
 
Gains/(Losses)
 
The following table sets forth the gains/(losses) included in earnings for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009 as a result of the firm electing to apply the fair value option to certain financial assets and financial liabilities, as described in Note 2. The table excludes gains and losses related to (i) trading assets, at fair value and trading liabilities, at fair value, (ii) gains and losses on assets and liabilities that would have been accounted for at fair value under other GAAP if the firm had not elected the fair value option, (iii) gains and losses on secured financings related to transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales, as such gains and losses are offset by gains and losses on the related financial assets, and (iv) gains and losses on subordinated liabilities issued by consolidated VIEs, as such gains and losses are offset by gains and losses on the financial assets held by the consolidated VIEs.
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings (1)
 $84  $(135)
Other secured financings (2)
  (4)  25 
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings (3)
  13   (67)
Receivables from customers and counterparties (4)
  (38)  (2)
Other liabilities and accrued expenses (5)(6)
  69   82 
Other (7)
  (3)  (26)
         
Total (8)
 $121  $(123)
         
 
 
  (1) Excludes gains of $575 million and $1.24 billion for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively, related to the embedded derivative component of hybrid financial instruments. Such gains and losses would have been recognized even if the firm had not elected to account for the entire hybrid instrument at fair value under the fair value option.
 
  (2) Excludes gains/(losses) of $(5) million and $19 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively, related to financings recorded as a result of transactions that were accounted for as secured financings rather than sales. Changes in the fair value of these secured financings are offset by changes in the fair value of the related financial instruments included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
  (3) Excludes losses of $205 million and $305 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively, related to the embedded derivative component of hybrid financial instruments. Such gains and losses would have been recognized even if the firm had not elected to account for the entire hybrid instrument at fair value under the fair value option.
 
  (4) Primarily consists of losses on certain reinsurance contracts.
 
  (5) Excludes gains of $107 million for the three months ended March 2010 related to subordinated liabilities issued by consolidated VIEs. Changes in the fair value of these financial instruments are offset by changes in the fair value of the financial assets held by the consolidated VIEs.
 
  (6) Primarily consists of gains on certain insurance and reinsurance contracts.
 
  (7) Primarily consists of gains/(losses) on resale and repurchase agreements, securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, and deposits.
 
  (8) Reported in “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. The amounts exclude contractual interest, which is included in “Interest income” and “Interest expense” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings, for all instruments other than hybrid financial instruments.

40


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
All trading assets and trading liabilities are accounted for at fair value either under the fair value option or as required by other accounting standards (principally ASC 320, ASC 940 and ASC 815). Excluding equities commissions of $881 million and $974 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively, and the gains and losses on the instruments accounted for under the fair value option described above, “Trading and principal investments” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings primarily represents gains and losses on “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
Loans and Loan Commitments
 
As of March 2010, the aggregate contractual principal amount of loans andlong-termreceivables for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $39.34 billion, including a difference of $34.47 billion related to loans with an aggregate fair value of $4.20 billion that were on nonaccrual status (including loans more than 90 days past due). As of December 2009, the aggregate contractual principal amount of loans andlong-termreceivables for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $41.96 billion, including a difference of $36.30 billion related to loans with an aggregate fair value of $4.28 billion that were on nonaccrual status (including loans more than 90 days past due). The aggregate contractual principal exceeds the related fair value primarily because the firm regularly purchases loans, such as distressed loans, at values significantly below contractual principal amounts.
 
As of March 2010 and December 2009, the fair value of unfunded lending commitments for which the fair value option was elected was a liability of $955 million and $879 million, respectively, and the related total contractual amount of these lending commitments was $44.48 billion and $44.05 billion, respectively.
 
Long-termDebt Instruments
 
The aggregate contractual principal amount oflong-termdebt instruments (principal andnon-principalprotected) for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $955 million and $752 million as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.

41


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Investments in Funds That Calculate Net Asset Value Per Share
 
The firm’s investments in funds that calculate net asset value per share primarily consist of investments in firm-sponsored funds where the firm co-invests withthird-partyinvestors. The private equity, private debt and real estate funds are primarily closed-end funds in which the firm’s investments are not eligible for redemption. Distributions will be received from these funds as the underlying assets are liquidated and it is estimated that substantially all of the underlying assets of these existing funds will be liquidated over the next 10 years. The firm’s investments in hedge funds are generally redeemable on a quarterly basis with 91 days notice, subject to a maximum redemption level of 25% of the firm’s initial investments at any quarter-end. The following table sets forth the fair value of the firm’s investments in and unfunded commitments to funds that calculate net asset value per share:
 
                 
  As of March 2010 As of December 2009
  Fair Value of
 Unfunded
 Fair Value of
 Unfunded
  Investments Commitments Investments Commitments
  (in millions)
Private equity funds (1)
 $7,463  $6,112  $8,229  $5,722 
Private debt funds (2)
  4,047   3,578   3,628   4,048 
Hedge funds (3)
  3,038      3,133    
Real estate and other funds (4)
  951   2,426   939   2,398 
                 
Total
 $15,499  $12,116  $15,929  $12,168 
                 
 
 
  (1) These funds primarily invest in a broad range of industries worldwide in a variety of situations, including leveraged buyouts, recapitalizations, and growth investments.
 
  (2) These funds generally invest in fixed income instruments and are focused on providing privatehigh-yieldcapital for mid to large-sized leveraged and management buyout transactions, recapitalizations, financings, refinancings, acquisitions and restructurings for private equity firms, private family companies and corporate issuers.
 
  (3) These funds are primarily multi-disciplinary hedge funds that employ a fundamentalbottom-upinvestment approach across various asset classes and strategies including long/short equity, credit, convertibles, risk arbitrage/special situations and capital structure arbitrage.
 
  (4) These funds invest globally, primarily in real estate companies, loan portfolios, debt recapitalizations and direct property.

42


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Collateralized Transactions
 
The firm receives financial instruments as collateral, primarily in connection with resale agreements, securities borrowed, derivative transactions and customer margin loans. Such financial instruments may include obligations of the U.S. government, federal agencies, sovereigns and corporations, as well as equities and convertible debentures.
 
In many cases, the firm is permitted to deliver or repledge these financial instruments in connection with entering into repurchase agreements, securities lending agreements and other secured financings, collateralizing derivative transactions and meeting firm or customer settlement requirements. As of March 2010 and December 2009, the fair value of financial instruments received as collateral by the firm that it was permitted to deliver or repledge was $615.83 billion and $561.77 billion, respectively, of which the firm delivered or repledged $440.15 billion and $392.89 billion, respectively.
 
The firm also pledges assets that it owns to counterparties who may or may not have the right to deliver or repledge them. Trading assets pledged to counterparties that have the right to deliver or repledge are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and were $43.28 billion and $31.49 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. Trading assets, pledged in connection with repurchase agreements, securities lending agreements and other secured financings to counterparties that did not have the right to sell or repledge are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and were $114.42 billion and $109.11 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. Other assets (primarily real estate and cash) owned and pledged in connection with other secured financings to counterparties that did not have the right to sell or repledge were $7.04 billion and $7.93 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
In addition to repurchase agreements and securities lending agreements, the firm obtains secured funding through the use of other arrangements. Other secured financings include arrangements that are nonrecourse, that is, only the subsidiary that executed the arrangement or a subsidiary guaranteeing the arrangement is obligated to repay the financing. Other secured financings consist of liabilities related to the firm’s William Street credit extension program; consolidated VIEs; collateralized central bank financings and other transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales (primarily pledged bank loans and mortgage whole loans); and other structured financing arrangements.

43


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Other secured financings by maturity are set forth in the table below:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Other secured financings(short-term) (1)(2)
 $10,842  $12,931 
Other secured financings(long-term):
        
2011
  2,316   3,832 
2012
  4,811   1,726 
2013
  1,265   1,518 
2014
  2,122   1,617 
2015-thereafter
  2,681   2,510 
         
Total other secured financings(long-term) (3)(4)(5)
  13,195   11,203 
         
Total other secured financings (6)(7)
 $24,037  $24,134 
         
 
 
  (1) As of March 2010 and December 2009, consists ofU.S. dollar-denominatedfinancings of $4.84 billion and $6.47 billion (including $4.65 billion and $6.15 billion at fair value) and non-U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $6.00 billion and $6.46 billion (including $927 million and $1.08 billion at fair value), respectively. As of March 2010 and December 2009, the U.S. dollar-denominated financings not at fair value had a weighted average interest rate of 4.11% and 3.44%, respectively, and thenon-U.S. dollar-denominatedfinancings not at fair value had a weighted average interest rate of 0.92% and 1.57%, respectively, after giving effect to hedging activities.
 
  (2) Includes other secured financings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and other secured financings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder.
 
  (3) As of March 2010 and December 2009, consists ofU.S. dollar-denominatedfinancings of $9.82 billion and $7.28 billion (including $8.35 billion and $5.90 billion at fair value) and non-U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $3.38 billion and $3.92 billion (including $2.06 billion and $2.10 billion at fair value), respectively. As of March 2010 and December 2009, the U.S. dollar-denominated financings not at fair value had a weighted average interest rate of 1.81% and 1.83%, respectively, and thenon-U.S. dollar-denominatedfinancings not at fair value had a weighted average interest rate of 2.76% and 2.30%, respectively, after giving effect to hedging activities.
 
  (4) Securedlong-termfinancings that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of the firm are reflected at their contractual maturity dates. Securedlong-termfinancings that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the dates such options become exercisable.
 
  (5) The aggregate contractual principal amount of other secured financings (long-term) for which the fair value option was elected, primarily consisting of transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales, debt raised through the William Street credit extension program and certain other nonrecourse financings, exceeded the related fair value by $398 million.
 
  (6) As of March 2010 and December 2009, $19.71 billion and $18.25 billion, respectively, of these financings were collateralized by trading assets and $4.33 billion and $5.88 billion, respectively, by other assets (primarily real estate and cash). Other secured financings include $9.77 billion and $10.63 billion of nonrecourse obligations as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (7) As of March 2010 and December 2009, other secured financings include $8.69 billion and $9.51 billion, respectively, related to transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales. Such financings were collateralized by financial assets included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition of $8.95 billion and $9.78 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.

44


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 4.  Securitization Activities and Variable Interest Entities
 
Securitization Activities
 
The firm securitizes residential and commercial mortgages, corporate bonds and other types of financial assets. The firm acts as underwriter of the beneficial interests that are sold to investors. The firm derecognizes financial assets transferred in securitizations, provided it has relinquished control over such assets. Transferred assets are accounted for at fair value prior to securitization. The firm generally receives cash in exchange for the transferred assets. Net revenues related to underwriting activities are recognized in connection with the sales of the underlying beneficial interests to investors.
 
The firm may have continuing involvement with transferred assets, including: retaining interests in securitized financial assets, primarily in the form of senior or subordinated securities; and retaining servicing rights. The firm may also purchase senior or subordinated securities in connection with secondarymarket-makingactivities. Retained interests and other interests related to the firm’s continuing involvement are accounted for at fair value and are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and are generally classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. See Note 2 for additional information regarding fair value measurement.
 
During the three months ended March 2010, the firm securitized $9.97 billion of financial assets in which the firm had continuing involvement, including $9.96 billion of residential mortgages, primarily in connection with government agency securitizations, and $14 million of other financial assets. During the three months ended March 2009, the firm securitized $3.57 billion of financial assets, including $3.47 billion of residential mortgages, primarily in connection with government agency securitizations, and $95 million of other financial assets. Cash flows received on retained interests were $199 million and $94 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively.

45


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The following table sets forth certain information related to the firm’s continuing involvement in securitization entities to which the firm sold assets, as well as the total outstanding principal amount of transferred assets in which the firm has continuing involvement, as of March 2010 and December 2009. The outstanding principal amount set forth in the table below is presented for the purpose of providing information about the size of the securitization entities in which the firm has continuing involvement, and is not representative of the firm’s risk of loss. For retained or purchased interests, the firm’s risk of loss is limited to the fair value of these interests.
 
                         
  As of March 2010 As of December 2009
  Outstanding
 Fair Value of
 Fair Value of
 Outstanding
 Fair Value of
 Fair Value of
  Principal
 Retained
 Purchased
 Principal
 Retained
 Purchased
  Amount Interests Interests (1) Amount Interests Interests (1)
  (in millions)
Residentialmortgage-backed (2)
 $61,790  $3,160  $10  $59,410  $3,956  $17 
Commercialmortgage-backed
  11,195   62   138   11,643   56   96 
Other (3)
  16,907   115   72   17,768   93   54 
                         
Total (4)
 $89,892  $3,337  $220  $88,821  $4,105  $167 
                         
 
 
  (1) Comprised of senior and subordinated interests in securitization-related entities purchased in connection with secondarymarket-makingactivities in which the firm also holds retained interests. In addition to these interests, the firm had other continuing involvement in the form of derivative transactions and guarantees with certain nonconsolidated VIEs for which the carrying value was a net liability of $70 million and $87 million as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. The notional amounts of these transactions are included in maximum exposure to loss in the nonconsolidated VIE table below.
 
  (2) Primarily consists of outstanding principal and retained interests related to government agency securitization entities.
 
  (3) Primarily consists of CDOs backed by corporate and mortgage obligations and CLOs.
 
  (4) Includes $7.57 billion of outstanding principal amount and $25 million of fair value of retained interests as of March 2010 related to securitization entities in which the firm’s only continuing involvement is retained servicing, which is not a variable interest.

46


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The following table sets forth the weighted average key economic assumptions used in measuring the fair value of the firm’s retained interests and the sensitivity of this fair value to immediate adverse changes of 10% and 20% in those assumptions:
 
                 
  As of March 2010 As of December 2009
  Type of Retained Interests Type of Retained Interests
  Mortgage-
   Mortgage-
  
  Backed Other (1) Backed Other (1)
  ($ in millions)
Fair value of retained interests
 $3,222  $115  $4,012  $93 
                 
Weighted average life (years)
  5.3   4.4   4.4   4.4 
                 
Constant prepayment rate (2)
  18.6%  N.M.   23.5%  N.M. 
Impact of 10% adverse change (2)
 $(46)  N.M.  $(44)  N.M. 
Impact of 20% adverse change (2)
  (86)  N.M.   (92)  N.M. 
                 
Discount rate (3)
  8.7%  N.M.   8.4%  N.M. 
Impact of 10% adverse change
 $(78)  N.M.  $(76)  N.M. 
Impact of 20% adverse change
  (143)  N.M.   (147)  N.M. 
 
 
  (1) Due to the nature and current fair value of certain of these retained interests, the weighted average assumptions for constant prepayment and discount rates and the related sensitivity to adverse changes are not meaningful as of March 2010 and December 2009. The firm’s maximum exposure to adverse changes in the value of these interests is the firm’s carrying value of $115 million and $93 million as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (2) Constant prepayment rate is included only for positions for which constant prepayment rate is a key assumption in the determination of fair value.
 
  (3) The majority of the firm’smortgage-backedretained interests are U.S. governmentagency-issuedcollateralized mortgage obligations, for which there is no anticipated credit loss. For the remainder of the firm’s retained interests, the expected credit loss assumptions are reflected within the discount rate.
 
The preceding table does not give effect to the offsetting benefit of other financial instruments that are held to mitigate risks inherent in these retained interests. Changes in fair value based on an adverse variation in assumptions generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumptions to the change in fair value is not usually linear. In addition, the impact of a change in a particular assumption is calculated independently of changes in any other assumption. In practice, simultaneous changes in assumptions might magnify or counteract the sensitivities disclosed above.
 
Variable Interest Entities
 
The firm, in the ordinary course of business, retains interests in VIEs in connection with its securitization activities. The firm also purchases and sells variable interests in VIEs, which primarily issue residential and commercialmortgage-backedand otherasset-backedsecurities, CDOs and CLOs, in connection with itsmarket-makingactivities and makes investments in and loans to VIEs that hold performing and nonperforming debt, equity, real estate, power-related and other assets. In addition, the firm utilizes VIEs to provide investors with principal-protected notes,credit-linkednotes andasset-repackagednotes designed to meet their objectives. VIEs generally purchase assets by issuing debt and equity instruments.
 
The firm’s variable interests in VIEs include senior and subordinated debt interests inmortgage-backedandasset-backedsecuritization vehicles, CDOs and CLOs; loan commitments; limited and general partnership interests; preferred and common stock; interest rate, foreign currency, equity, commodity and credit derivatives; and guarantees.

47


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The firm’s exposure to the obligations of VIEs is generally limited to its interests in these entities. In the tables set forth below, the maximum exposure to loss for retained and purchased interests and loans and investments is the carrying value of these interests. In certain instances, the firm provides guarantees, including derivative guarantees, to VIEs or holders of variable interests in VIEs. For these contracts, maximum exposure to loss set forth in the tables below is the notional amount of such guarantees, which does not represent anticipated losses and also has not been reduced by unrealized losses already recorded by the firm in connection with these guarantees. As a result, the maximum exposure to loss exceeds the firm’s liabilities related to VIEs. The firm has aggregated nonconsolidated VIEs based on principal business activity, as reflected in the tables below. The nature of the firm’s variable interests can take different forms, as described in the rows under maximum exposure to loss.
 
The following tables set forth total assets in nonconsolidated VIEs in which the firm holds variable interests, the firm’s maximum exposure to loss excluding the benefit of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate the risks associated with these variable interests and the total assets and total liabilities included in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition related to the firm’s variable interests in these nonconsolidated VIEs. For March 2010, in accordance with ASU Nos.2009-16 and2009-17, the following table also includes nonconsolidated VIEs in which the firm holds variable interests (and to which the firm sold assets and has continuing involvement as of March 2010) that were formerly considered to be QSPEs prior to the adoption of these standards.
 
                             
  As of March 2010
      Real estate,
        
    Corporate
 credit-related
 Other
      
  Mortgage-
 CDOs and
 and other
 asset-
 Power-
 Investment
  
  backed (1) CLOs (1) investing (2) backed (1) related (3) funds (4) Total
  (in millions)
Assets in VIE
 $78,648 (6) $22,732  $14,676  $1,781  $580  $1,888  $120,305 
                             
Carrying Value of the Firm’s Variable Interests                            
                             
Assets
 $3,773  $1,180  $1,322  $26  $236  $7  $6,544 
Liabilities
  4   219   173   14   1      411 
                             
Maximum Exposure to Loss in Nonconsolidated VIEs (5)                            
                             
Retained interests
 $3,197  $102  $  $13  $  $  $3,312 
Purchased interests
  363   223               586 
Commitments and guarantees
     65   276      37      378 (9)
Derivatives
  4,092 (6)(7)  7,258 (8)     1,383         12,733 (9)
Loans and investments
  165      1,322      236   7   1,730 
                             
Total
 $7,817  $7,648  $1,598  $1,396  $273  $7  $18,739 
                             
 

48


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
                             
  As of December 2009
      Real estate,
        
    Corporate
 credit-related
 Other
   Principal-
  
  Mortgage
 CDOs and
 and other
 asset-
 Power-
 protected
  
  CDOs (1) CLOs (1) investing (2) backed (1) related (3) notes (10) Total
  (in millions)
Assets in VIE
 $9,114  $32,490  $22,618  $497  $592  $2,209  $67,520 
                             
Carrying Value of the Firm’s Variable Interests                            
                             
Assets
 $182  $834  $2,386  $16  $224  $12  $3,654 
Liabilities
  10   400   204   12   3   1,357   1,986 
                             
Maximum Exposure to Loss in Nonconsolidated VIEs (5)                            
                             
Retained and purchased interests
  135   259               394 
Commitments and guarantees
     3   397      37      437 (9)
Derivatives
  4,111 (7)  7,577 (8)     497      2,512   14,697 (9)
Loans and investments
        2,425      224      2,649 
                             
Total
 $4,246  $7,839  $2,822  $497  $261  $2,512  $18,177 
                             
 
 
  (1) These VIEs are generally financed through the issuance of debt instruments collateralized by assets held by the VIE. Substantially all assets and liabilities held by the firm related to these VIEs are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
  (2) The firm obtains interests in these VIEs in connection with making investments in real estate, distressed loans and other types of debt, mezzanine instruments and equities. These VIEs are generally financed through the issuance of debt and equity instruments which are either collateralized by or indexed to assets held by the VIE. Substantially all assets and liabilities held by the firm related to these VIEs are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Other assets,” and “Other liabilities and accrued expenses,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
  (3) These VIEs are financed through the issuance of debt instruments. Assets and liabilities held by the firm related to these VIEs are included in “Other assets” and “Other liabilities and accrued expenses,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
  (4) These VIEs are generally financed through the issuance of equity instruments. Assets and liabilities held by the firm related to these VIEs are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Other liabilities and accrued expenses,” respectively, in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.
 
  (5) Such amounts do not represent the anticipated losses in connection with these transactions because they exclude the effect of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate these risks.
 
  (6) Assets in VIE and maximum exposure to loss include $7.15 billion and $4.09 billion, respectively, related to CDOs backed by mortgage obligations.
 
  (7) Primarily consists of written protection oninvestment-grade,short-termcollateral held by VIEs that have issued CDOs.
 
  (8) Primarily consists of total return swaps on CDOs and CLOs. The firm has generally transferred the risks related to the underlying securities through derivatives withnon-VIEs.
 
  (9) The aggregate amounts include $4.53 billion and $4.66 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, related to guarantees and derivative transactions with VIEs to which the firm transferred assets.
 
(10) Consists ofout-of-the-moneywritten put options that provide principal protection to clients invested in various fund products, with risk to the firm mitigated through portfolio rebalancing. Assets related to these VIEs are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and liabilities related to these VIEs are included in “Other secured financings,” “Unsecuredshort-termborrowings, including the current portion of unsecuredlong-termborrowings” or “Unsecuredlong-termborrowings” in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition. Assets in VIE, carrying value of liabilities and maximum exposure to loss exclude $3.97 billion as of December 2009, associated with guarantees related to the firm’s performance under borrowings from the VIE, which are recorded as liabilities in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition. Substantially all of the liabilities included in the table above relate to additional borrowings from the VIE associated with principal protected notes guaranteed by the firm. These VIEs were consolidated by the firm upon adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17.

49


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
The following tables set forth the carrying amount and classification of the firm’s assets and liabilities, excluding the benefit of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate the risks associated with its variable interests, in consolidated VIEs. For March 2010, in accordance with ASUNo. 2009-17,the following table excludes VIEs in which the firm holds a majority voting interest if (i) the VIE meets the definition of a business as defined in ASC 805 and (ii) the VIE’s assets can be used for purposes other than the settlement of its obligations. For December 2009, prior to the adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17,the following table excludes VIEs in which the firm holds a majority voting interest unless the activities of the VIE are primarily related to securitization,asset-backedfinancings or single-lessee leasing arrangements. The increase in total assets of consolidated VIEs from December 2009 to March 2010 is primarily related to (i) VIEs that are required to be disclosed in accordance with ASUNo. 2009-17that were not required to be disclosed under previous GAAP, as described above, and (ii) VIEs that were consolidated by the firm upon adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17.
 
The firm has aggregated consolidated VIEs based on principal business activity, as reflected in the table below. Consolidated VIE assets and liabilities are presented after intercompany eliminations and include assets financed on a nonrecourse basis.
 
                     
  As of March 2010
      CDOs,
    
  Real estate,
   mortgage-
    
  credit-related
   backed and
 Principal-
  
  and other
 Municipal bond
 other asset-
 protected
  
  investing (1) securitizations (2) backed (3) notes (4) Total
  (in millions)
Assets (5)
                    
Cash and cash equivalents
 $248  $  $160  $375  $783 
Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes
  149            149 
Receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
  11      1      12 
Receivables from customers and counterparties
  2      48      50 
Trading assets, at fair value
  3,271   704   416   797   5,188 
Other assets
  3,668      546      4,214 
                     
Total
 $7,349  $704  $1,171  $1,172  $10,396 
                     
Liabilities
                    
Other secured financings
 $2,997  $803  $1,058  $3,227  $8,085 
Payables to customers and counterparties
  4      32      36 
Trading liabilities, at fair value
        6      6 
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings, including the current portion of unsecuredlong-termborrowings
  234         2,956   3,190 
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings
  27         157   184 
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
  2,435      24      2,459 
                     
Total
 $5,697  $803  $1,120  $6,340  $13,960 
                     
 

50


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
                         
  As of December 2009
      CDOs,
      
  Real estate,
   mortgage-
   Foreign
  
  credit-related
   backed and
 Principal-
 exchange
  
  and other
 Municipal bond
 other asset-
 protected
 and
  
  investing (1) securitizations (2) backed (3) notes (4) commodities Total
  (in millions)
Assets
                        
Cash and cash equivalents
 $13  $  $  $  $13  $26 
Receivables from customers and counterparties
  1               1 
Trading assets, at fair value
  721   679   639   214   134   2,387 
Other assets
  207            80   287 
                         
Total
 $942  $679  $639  $214  $227  $2,701 
                         
Liabilities
                        
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
 $  $  $432  $  $  $432 
Other secured financings
  620   782   151         1,553 
Payables to customers and counterparties
  1               1 
Trading liabilities, at fair value
              169   169 
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings, including the current portion of unsecuredlong-termborrowings
           214      214 
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
  59            10   69 
                         
Total
 $680  $782  $583  $214  $179  $2,438 
                         
 
 
(1)  These VIEs are generally financed through the issuance of subordinated liabilities and debt and equity instruments. The VIE liabilities are generally collateralized by or indexed to the related VIE assets and generally do not provide for recourse to the general credit of the firm.
 
(2)  These VIEs are generally financed through the issuance of debt instruments and the VIE liabilities are partially collateralized by the related VIE assets.
 
(3)  These VIEs are generally financed through the issuance of debt instruments collateralized by assets held by the VIE and the VIE liabilities generally do not provide for recourse to the general credit of the firm.
 
(4)  These VIEs are financed through the issuance of debt instruments.
 
(5)  Substantially all VIE assets can be used only to settle obligations of the VIE.
 
The firm did not haveoff-balance-sheetcommitments to purchase or finance any CDOs held by structured investment vehicles as of March 2010 or December 2009.

51


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 5.  Deposits
 
The following table sets forth deposits as of March 2010 and December 2009:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
U.S. offices (1)
 $31,381  $32,797 
Non-U.S. offices (2)
  7,050   6,621 
         
Total
 $38,431  $39,418 
         
 
 
  (1) Substantially all U.S. deposits were interest-bearing and were held at GS Bank USA.
 
  (2) Substantially allnon-U.S. depositswere interest-bearing and were held at Goldman Sachs Bank (Europe) PLC (GS Bank Europe).
 
Included in the above table are time deposits of $9.46 billion and $9.30 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. The following table sets forth the maturities of time deposits as of March 2010:
 
             
  As of March 2010
  U.S. Non-U.S. Total
  (in millions)
2010
 $1,416  $1,072  $2,488 
2011
  1,630   24   1,654 
2012
  886      886 
2013
  1,830      1,830 
2014
  484      484 
2015-thereafter
  2,121      2,121 
             
Total
 $8,367  $1,096  $9,463 
             

52


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 6.  Short-TermBorrowings
 
As of March 2010 and December 2009,short-termborrowings were $51.62 billion and $50.45 billion, respectively, comprised of $10.84 billion and $12.93 billion, respectively, included in “Other secured financings” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and $40.78 billion and $37.52 billion, respectively, of unsecuredshort-termborrowings. See Note 3 for information on other secured financings.
 
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings include the portion of unsecuredlong-termborrowings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and unsecuredlong-termborrowings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder. The firm accounts for promissory notes, commercial paper and certain hybrid financial instruments at fair value under the fair value option.Short-termborrowings that are not recorded at fair value are recorded based on the amount of cash received plus accrued interest, and such amounts approximate fair value due to theshort-termnature of the obligations.
 
Unsecuredshort-termborrowings are set forth below:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Current portion of unsecuredlong-termborrowings (1)
 $19,210  $17,928 
Hybrid financial instruments
  13,302   10,741 
Promissory notes
  2,402   2,119 
Commercial paper
  1,328   1,660 
Othershort-termborrowings
  4,542   5,068 
         
Total (2)
 $40,784  $37,516 
         
 
 
  (1) Includes $3.73 billion and $1.73 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) under the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (TLGP).
 
  (2) The weighted average interest rates for these borrowings, after giving effect to hedging activities, were 1.71% and 1.31% as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, and excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under the fair value option.

53


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 7.  Long-TermBorrowings
 
As of March 2010 and December 2009,long-termborrowings were $193.61 billion and $196.29 billion, respectively, comprised of $13.20 billion and $11.20 billion, respectively, included in “Other secured financings” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition and $180.41 billion and $185.09 billion, respectively, of unsecuredlong-termborrowings. See Note 3 for information regarding other secured financings.
 
The firm’s unsecuredlong-termborrowings extend through 2043 and consist principally of senior borrowings.
 
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings are set forth below:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Fixed rate obligations (1)
 $116,434  $117,413 
Floating rate obligations (2)
  63,980   67,672 
         
Total (3)
 $180,414  $185,085 
         
 
 
  (1) As of March 2010 and December 2009, $77.54 billion and $79.12 billion, respectively, of the firm’s fixed rate debt obligations were denominated in U.S. dollars and interest rates ranged from 1.63% to 10.04% as of both March 2010 and December 2009. As of March 2010 and December 2009, $38.89 billion and $38.29 billion, respectively, of the firm’s fixed rate debt obligations were denominated innon-U.S. dollarsand interest rates ranged from 0.80% to 8.64% and 0.80% to 7.45%, respectively.
 
  (2) As of March 2010 and December 2009, $31.92 billion and $32.26 billion, respectively, of the firm’s floating rate debt obligations were denominated in U.S. dollars. As of March 2010 and December 2009, $32.06 billion and $35.41 billion, respectively, of the firm’s floating rate debt obligations were denominated innon-U.S. dollars.Floating interest rates generally are based on LIBOR or the federal funds target rate.Equity-linkedand indexed instruments are included in floating rate obligations.
 
  (3) Includes $16.96 billion and $19.03 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP.

54


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings by maturity date are set forth below:
 
     
  As of
  March 2010
  (in millions)
2011
 $17,871 
2012
  25,695 
2013
  22,864 
2014
  17,872 
2015
  13,804 
2016-thereafter
  82,308 
     
Total (1)(2)(3)(4)
 $180,414 
     
 
 
  (1) Unsecuredlong-termborrowings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and unsecuredlong-termborrowings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder are included as unsecuredshort-termborrowings in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
  (2) Unsecuredlong-termborrowings that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of the firm are reflected at their contractual maturity dates. Unsecuredlong-termborrowings that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the dates such options become exercisable.
 
  (3) Amount includes an increase of $6.44 billion to the carrying amount of certain of the firm’s unsecuredlong-termborrowings related to fair value hedges. The amounts related to the carrying value of the firm’s unsecuredlong-termborrowings associated with fair value hedges by year of maturity are as follows: $71 million in 2011, $520 million in 2012, $730 million in 2013, $710 million in 2014, $322 million in 2015 and $4.08 billion in 2016 and thereafter.
 
  (4) The aggregate contractual principal amount of unsecuredlong-termborrowings (principal andnon-principalprotected) for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $557 million.
 
The firm designates certain derivative contracts as fair value hedges to effectively convert a substantial portion of its unsecuredlong-termborrowings which are not accounted for at fair value into floating rate obligations. Accordingly, excluding the cumulative impact of changes in the firm’s credit spreads, the carrying value of unsecuredlong-termborrowings approximated fair value as of March 2010 and December 2009. For unsecuredlong-termborrowings for which the firm did not elect the fair value option, the cumulative impact due to the widening of the firm’s own credit spreads would be a reduction in the carrying value of total unsecuredlong-termborrowings of less than 1% as of both March 2010 and December 2009.
 
The effective weighted average interest rates for unsecuredlong-termborrowings are set forth below:
 
                 
  As of
  March 2010 December 2009
  Amount Rate Amount Rate
  ($ in millions)
Fixed rate obligations
 $5,756   4.93% $4,320   5.49%
Floating rate obligations (1)(2)
  174,658   1.57   180,765   1.33 
                 
Total
 $180,414   1.68  $185,085   1.42 
                 
 
 
  (1) Includes fixed rate obligations that have been converted into floating rate obligations through hedge accounting.
 
  (2) The weighted average interest rates as of March 2010 and December 2009 excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under the fair value option.

55


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Subordinated Borrowings
 
As of March 2010 and December 2009, unsecuredlong-termborrowings were comprised of subordinated borrowings with outstanding principal amounts of $19.00 billion and $19.16 billion, respectively, as set forth below.
 
Junior Subordinated Debt Issued to Trusts in Connection withFixed-to-Floatingand Floating Rate Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities.  In 2007, Group Inc. issued a total of $2.25 billion of remarketable junior subordinated debt to Goldman Sachs Capital II and Goldman Sachs Capital III (APEX Trusts), Delaware statutory trusts that, in turn, issued $2.25 billion of guaranteed perpetual Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities (APEX) to third parties and a de minimis amount of common securities to Group Inc. Group Inc. also entered into contracts with the APEX Trusts to sell $2.25 billion of perpetualnon-cumulativepreferred stock to be issued by Group Inc. (the stock purchase contracts). The APEX Trusts are wholly owned finance subsidiaries of the firm for regulatory and legal purposes but are not consolidated for accounting purposes.
 
The firm pays interestsemi-annuallyon $1.75 billion of junior subordinated debt issued to Goldman Sachs Capital II at a fixed annual rate of 5.59% and the debt matures on June 1, 2043. The firm pays interest quarterly on $500 million of junior subordinated debt issued to Goldman Sachs Capital III at a rate per annum equal tothree-monthLIBOR plus 0.57% and the debt matures on September 1, 2043. In addition, the firm makes contract payments at a rate of 0.20% per annum on the stock purchase contracts held by the APEX Trusts. The firm has the right to defer payments on the junior subordinated debt and the stock purchase contracts, subject to limitations, and therefore cause payment on the APEX to be deferred. During any such extension period, the firm will not be permitted to, among other things, pay dividends on or make certain repurchases of its common or preferred stock. The junior subordinated debt is junior in right of payment to all of Group Inc.’s senior indebtedness and all of Group Inc.’s other subordinated borrowings.
 
In connection with the APEX issuance, the firm covenanted in favor of certain of its debtholders, who are initially the holders of Group Inc.’s 6.345% Junior Subordinated Debentures due February 15, 2034, that, subject to certain exceptions, the firm would not redeem or purchase (i) Group Inc.’s junior subordinated debt issued to the APEX Trusts prior to the applicable stock purchase date or (ii) APEX or shares of Group Inc.’s Series E or Series F Preferred Stock prior to the date that is ten years after the applicable stock purchase date, unless the applicable redemption or purchase price does not exceed a maximum amount determined by reference to the aggregate amount of net cash proceeds that the firm has received from the sale of qualifying equity securities during the180-dayperiod preceding the redemption or purchase.
 
The firm accounted for the stock purchase contracts as equity instruments and, accordingly, recorded the cost of the stock purchase contracts as a reduction to additionalpaid-incapital. See Note 9 for information on the preferred stock that Group Inc. will issue in connection with the stock purchase contracts.
 
Junior Subordinated Debt Issued to a Trust in Connection with Trust Preferred Securities.  Group Inc. issued $2.84 billion of junior subordinated debentures in 2004 to Goldman Sachs Capital I (Trust), a Delaware statutory trust that, in turn, issued $2.75 billion of guaranteed preferred beneficial interests to third parties and $85 million of common beneficial interests to Group Inc. and invested the proceeds from the sale in junior subordinated debentures issued by Group Inc. The Trust is a wholly owned finance subsidiary of the firm for regulatory and legal purposes but is not consolidated for accounting purposes.

56


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The firm pays interestsemi-annuallyon these debentures at an annual rate of 6.345% and the debentures mature on February 15, 2034. The coupon rate and the payment dates applicable to the beneficial interests are the same as the interest rate and payment dates applicable to the debentures. The firm has the right, from time to time, to defer payment of interest on the debentures, and, therefore, cause payment on the Trust’s preferred beneficial interests to be deferred, in each case up to ten consecutivesemi-annualperiods. During any such extension period, the firm will not be permitted to, among other things, pay dividends on or make certain repurchases of its common stock. The Trust is not permitted to pay any distributions on the common beneficial interests held by Group Inc. unless all dividends payable on the preferred beneficial interests have been paid in full. These debentures are junior in right of payment to all of Group Inc.’s senior indebtedness and all of Group Inc.’s subordinated borrowings, other than the junior subordinated debt issued in connection with the APEX.
 
Subordinated Debt.  As of March 2010, the firm had $13.91 billion of other subordinated debt outstanding with maturities ranging from 2012 to 2038. The effective weighted average interest rate on this debt was 1.03%, after giving effect to fair value hedges that effectively convert fixed rate obligations into floating rate obligations. As of December 2009, the firm had $14.07 billion of other subordinated debt outstanding with maturities ranging from 2012 to 2038. The effective weighted average interest rate on this debt was 1.51%, after giving effect to derivative contracts used to convert fixed rate obligations into floating rate obligations. This debt is junior in right of payment to all of the firm’s senior indebtedness.

57


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 8.  Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees
 
Commitments
 
The following table summarizes the firm’s commitments as of March 2010 and December 2009:
 
                         
  Commitment Amount by Period
  
  of Expiration as of March 2010 Total Commitments as of
  Remainder
 2011-
 2013-
 2015-
 March
 December
  of 2010 2012 2014 Thereafter 2010 2009
  (in millions)
Commitments to extend credit (1)
                        
Commercial lending:
                        
Investment-grade
 $3,279  $6,185  $1,296  $  $10,760  $11,415 
Non-investment-grade
  4,664   3,953   2,133   1,493   12,243   8,153 
William Street credit extension program
  3,948   18,398   3,263   319   25,928   25,218 
Warehouse financing
  15            15   12 
                         
Total commitments to extend credit
  11,906   28,536   6,692   1,812   48,946   44,798 
Forward starting resale and securities borrowing agreements
  58,751            58,751   34,844 
Forward starting repurchase and securities lending agreements
  15,975            15,975   10,545 
Underwriting commitments
  75            75   1,811 
Letters of credit (2)
  1,516   268   146   4   1,934   1,804 
Investment commitments (3)
  2,137   9,080   172   1,146   12,535   13,240 
Other (4)
  179   54   41   31   305   380 
                         
Total commitments
 $90,539  $37,938  $7,051  $2,993  $138,521  $107,422 
                         
 
 
(1)  Commitments to extend credit are presented net of amounts syndicated to third parties.
 
(2)  Consists of commitments under letters of credit issued by various banks which the firm provides to counterparties in lieu of securities or cash to satisfy various collateral and margin deposit requirements.
 
(3)  Consists of the firm’s commitments to invest in private equity, real estate and other assets directly and through funds that the firm raises and manages in connection with its merchant banking and other investing activities, consisting of $2.43 billion and $2.46 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, related to real estate private investments and $10.11 billion and $10.78 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, related to corporate and other private investments. Such commitments include $11.43 billion and $11.38 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, of commitments to invest in funds managed by the firm, which will be funded at market value on the date of investment.
 
(4)  Includes commitments of $52 million and $104 million as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, related to the firm’s new headquarters in New York City.

58


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Commitments to Extend Credit.  The firm’s commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to counterparties that have fixed termination dates and are contingent on the satisfaction of all conditions to borrowing set forth in the contract. Since these commitments may expire unused or be reduced or cancelled at the counterparty’s request, the total commitment amount does not necessarily reflect the actual future cash flow requirements. The firm accounts for these commitments at fair value. To the extent that the firm recognizes losses on these commitments, such losses are recorded within the firm’s Trading and Principal Investments segment net of any related underwriting fees.
 
  • Commercial lending commitments.  The firm’s commercial lending commitments are generally extended in connection with contingent acquisition financing and other types of corporate lending as well as commercial real estate financing. The total commitment amount does not necessarily reflect the actual future cash flow requirements, as the firm may syndicate all or substantial portions of these commitments in the future, the commitments may expire unused, or the commitments may be cancelled or reduced at the request of the counterparty. In addition, commitments that are extended for contingent acquisition financing are often intended to beshort-termin nature, as borrowers often seek to replace them with other funding sources.
 
  • William Street credit extension program.  Substantially all of the commitments provided under the William Street credit extension program are toinvestment-gradecorporate borrowers. Commitments under the program are principally extended by William Street Commitment Corporation (Commitment Corp.), a consolidated wholly owned subsidiary of GS Bank USA, GS Bank USA and other subsidiaries of GS Bank USA. The commitments extended by Commitment Corp. are supported, in part, by funding raised by William Street Funding Corporation (Funding Corp.), another consolidated wholly owned subsidiary of GS Bank USA. The assets and liabilities of Commitment Corp. and Funding Corp. are legally separated from other assets and liabilities of the firm. The assets of Commitment Corp. and of Funding Corp. will not be available to their respective shareholders until the claims of their respective creditors have been paid. In addition, no affiliate of either Commitment Corp. or Funding Corp., except in limited cases as expressly agreed in writing, is responsible for any obligation of either entity. With respect to most of the William Street commitments, Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, Inc. (SMFG) provides the firm with credit loss protection that is generally limited to 95% of the first loss the firm realizes on approved loan commitments, up to a maximum of approximately $950 million. In addition, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, upon the firm’s request, SMFG will provide protection for 70% of additional losses on such commitments, up to a maximum of $1.13 billion, of which $375 million of protection had been provided as of both March 2010 and December 2009. The firm also uses other financial instruments to mitigate credit risks related to certain William Street commitments not covered by SMFG.
 
  • Warehouse financing.  The firm provides financing for the warehousing of financial assets. These arrangements are secured by the warehoused assets, primarily consisting of commercial mortgages as of March 2010 and December 2009.

59


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
Leases.  The firm has contractual obligations underlong-termnoncancelable lease agreements, principally for office space, expiring on various dates through 2069. Certain agreements are subject to periodic escalation provisions for increases in real estate taxes and other charges. Future minimum rental payments, net of minimum sublease rentals are set forth below:
 
     
  As of
  March 2010
  (in millions)
Remainder of 2010
 $376 
2011
  416 
2012
  349 
2013
  306 
2014
  202 
2015-thereafter
  1,559 
     
Total
 $3,208 
     
 
Contingencies
 
The firm is involved in a number of judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of its businesses. Management believes, based on currently available information, that the results of such proceedings, in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the firm’s financial condition, but may be material to the firm’s operating results for any particular period, depending, in part, upon the operating results for such period. Given the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of the firm’s litigation and regulatory matters, particularly in cases or proceedings in which substantial or indeterminate damages or fines are sought, the firm cannot estimate losses or ranges of losses for cases or proceedings where there is only a reasonable possibility that a loss may be incurred.
 
In connection with its insurance business, the firm is contingently liable to provide guaranteed minimum death and income benefits to certain contract holders and has established a reserve related to $6.29 billion and $6.35 billion of contract holder account balances as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, for such benefits. The weighted average attained age of these contract holders was 68 years as of both March 2010 and December 2009. The net amount at risk, representing guaranteed minimum death and income benefits in excess of contract holder account balances, was $1.88 billion and $1.96 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. See Note 12 for more information on the firm’s insurance liabilities.

60


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Guarantees
 
The firm enters into various derivative contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee under ASC 460. Disclosures about derivative contracts are not required if such contracts may be cash settled and the firm has no basis to conclude it is probable that the counterparties held, at inception, the underlying instruments related to the derivative contracts. The firm has concluded that these conditions have been met for certain large, internationally active commercial and investment bank counterparties and certain other counterparties. Accordingly, the firm has not included such contracts in the tables below.
 
The firm, in its capacity as an agency lender, indemnifies most of its securities lending customers against losses incurred in the event that borrowers do not return securities and the collateral held is insufficient to cover the market value of the securities borrowed.
 
In the ordinary course of business, the firm provides other financial guarantees of the obligations of third parties (e.g., standby letters of credit and other guarantees to enable clients to complete transactions and merchant banking fund-related guarantees). These guarantees represent obligations to make payments to beneficiaries if the guaranteed party fails to fulfill its obligation under a contractual arrangement with that beneficiary.
 
The following table sets forth certain information about the firm’s derivative contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee and certain other guarantees as of March 2010. Derivative contracts set forth below include written equity and commodity put options, written currency contracts and interest rate caps, floors and swaptions. See Note 3 for information regarding credit derivative contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee, which are not included below.
 
                         
    Maximum Payout/
  Carrying
 Notional Amount by Period of Expiration (1)
  Value of
   2011-
 2013-
 2015-
  
  Net Liability 2010 2012 2014 Thereafter Total
  (in millions)
As of March 2010
                        
Derivatives (2)
 $6,598  $155,292  $173,598  $51,637  $63,701  $444,228 
Securities lending indemnifications (3)
     27,728            27,728 
Other financial guarantees (4)
  190   352   329   344   961   1,986 
 
 
  (1) Such amounts do not represent the anticipated losses in connection with these contracts.
 
  (2) Because derivative contracts are accounted for at fair value, carrying value is considered the best indication of payment/performance risk for individual contracts. However, the carrying value excludes the effect of a legal right of setoff that may exist under an enforceable netting agreement and the effect of netting of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements. These derivative contracts are risk managed together with derivative contracts that do not meet the definition of a guarantee under ASC 460 and, therefore, these amounts do not reflect the firm’s overall risk related to its derivative activities. As of December 2009, the carrying value of the net liability related to derivative guarantees was $7.22 billion.
 
  (3) Collateral held by the lenders in connection with securities lending indemnifications was $28.58 billion as of March 2010. Because the contractual nature of these arrangements requires the firm to obtain collateral with a market value that exceeds the value of the securities on loan from the borrower, there is minimal performance risk associated with these guarantees.
 
  (4) As of December 2009, the carrying value of the net liability related to other financial guarantees was $207 million.

61


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The firm has established trusts, including Goldman Sachs Capital I, II and III, and other entities for the limited purpose of issuing securities to third parties, lending the proceeds to the firm and entering into contractual arrangements with the firm and third parties related to this purpose. See Note 7 for information regarding the transactions involving Goldman Sachs Capital I, II and III. The firm effectively provides for the full and unconditional guarantee of the securities issued by these entities, which are not consolidated for accounting purposes. Timely payment by the firm of amounts due to these entities under the borrowing, preferred stock and related contractual arrangements will be sufficient to cover payments due on the securities issued by these entities. Management believes that it is unlikely that any circumstances will occur, such as nonperformance on the part of paying agents or other service providers, that would make it necessary for the firm to make payments related to these entities other than those required under the terms of the borrowing, preferred stock and related contractual arrangements and in connection with certain expenses incurred by these entities. Group Inc. also fully and unconditionally guarantees the securities issued by GS Finance Corp., a wholly owned finance subsidiary of the firm, which is consolidated for accounting purposes.
 
In the ordinary course of business, the firm indemnifies and guarantees certain service providers, such as clearing and custody agents, trustees and administrators, against specified potential losses in connection with their acting as an agent of, or providing services to, the firm or its affiliates. The firm also indemnifies some clients against potential losses incurred in the event specifiedthird-partyservice providers, includingsub-custodiansandthird-partybrokers, improperly execute transactions. In addition, the firm is a member of payment, clearing and settlement networks as well as securities exchanges around the world that may require the firm to meet the obligations of such networks and exchanges in the event of member defaults. In connection with its prime brokerage and clearing businesses, the firm agrees to clear and settle on behalf of its clients the transactions entered into by them with other brokerage firms. The firm’s obligations in respect of such transactions are secured by the assets in the client’s account as well as any proceeds received from the transactions cleared and settled by the firm on behalf of the client. In connection with joint venture investments, the firm may issue loan guarantees under which it may be liable in the event of fraud, misappropriation, environmental liabilities and certain other matters involving the borrower. The firm is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under these guarantees and indemnifications. However, management believes that it is unlikely the firm will have to make any material payments under these arrangements, and no liabilities related to these guarantees and indemnifications have been recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition as of March 2010 and December 2009.
 
The firm provides representations and warranties to counterparties in connection with a variety of commercial transactions and occasionally indemnifies them against potential losses caused by the breach of those representations and warranties. The firm may also provide indemnifications protecting against changes in or adverse application of certain U.S. tax laws in connection with ordinary-course transactions such as securities issuances, borrowings or derivatives. In addition, the firm may provide indemnifications to some counterparties to protect them in the event additional taxes are owed or payments are withheld, due either to a change in or an adverse application of certainnon-U.S. taxlaws. These indemnifications generally are standard contractual terms and are entered into in the ordinary course of business. Generally, there are no stated or notional amounts included in these indemnifications, and the contingencies triggering the obligation to indemnify are not expected to occur. The firm is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under these guarantees and indemnifications. However, management believes that it is unlikely the firm will have to make any material payments under these arrangements, and no liabilities related to these arrangements have been recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition as of March 2010 and December 2009.

62


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 9.  Shareholders’ Equity
 
Common and Preferred Equity
 
On April 19, 2010, the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (Board) declared a dividend of $0.35 per common share to be paid on June 29, 2010 to common shareholders of record on June 1, 2010.
 
During the three months ended March 2010, the firm repurchased 13.2 million shares of its common stock at an average cost per share of $172.15, for a total cost of $2.27 billion. In addition, to satisfy minimum statutory employee tax withholding requirements related to the delivery of common stock underlying RSUs, the firm cancelled 6.1 million of RSUs with a total value of $962 million during the three months ended March 2010.
 
The firm’s share repurchase program is intended to substantially offset increases in share count over time resulting from employeeshare-basedcompensation and to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity. The repurchase program is effected primarily through regularopen-marketpurchases, the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by the firm’s issuance of shares resulting from employeeshare-basedcompensation as well as its current and projected capital position (i.e., comparisons of the firm’s desired level of capital to its actual level of capital), but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of the firm’s common stock. Any repurchase of the firm’s common stock requires approval by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board).
 
As of March 2010, the firm had 174,000 shares of perpetual preferred stock issued and outstanding as set forth in the following table:
 
                   
            Redemption
  Dividend
 Shares
 Shares
   Earliest
 Value
Series Preference Issued Authorized Dividend Rate Redemption Date (in millions)
A
 Non-cumulative  30,000   50,000  3 month LIBOR + 0.75%,
with floor of 3.75% per annum
 April 25, 2010 $750 
                   
B
 Non-cumulative  32,000   50,000  6.20% per annum October 31, 2010  800 
                   
C
 Non-cumulative  8,000   25,000  3 month LIBOR + 0.75%,
with floor of 4.00% per annum
 October 31, 2010  200 
                   
D
 Non-cumulative  54,000   60,000  3 month LIBOR + 0.67%,
with floor of 4.00% per annum
 May 24, 2011  1,350 
                   
G
 Cumulative  50,000   50,000  10.00% per annum October 1, 2008  5,500 
                   
     174,000   235,000      $8,600 
                   
 
Each share ofnon-cumulativepreferred stock issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $25,000, is represented by 1,000 depositary shares and is redeemable at the firm’s option, subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Board, at a redemption price equal to $25,000 plus declared and unpaid dividends.
 
Each share of 10% Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series G (Series G Preferred Stock) issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $100,000 and is redeemable at the firm’s option, subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Board, at a redemption price equal to $110,000 plus accrued and unpaid dividends. In connection with the issuance of the Series G Preferred Stock, the firm issued a five-year warrant to purchase up to 43.5 million shares of common stock at an exercise price of $115.00 per share. The warrant is exercisable at any time until October 1, 2013 and the number of shares of common stock underlying the warrant and the exercise price are subject to adjustment for certain dilutive events.

63


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
All series of preferred stock are pari passu and have a preference over the firm’s common stock upon liquidation. Dividends on each series of preferred stock, if declared, are payable quarterly in arrears. The firm’s ability to declare or pay dividends on, or purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire, its common stock is subject to certain restrictions in the event that the firm fails to pay or set aside full dividends on the preferred stock for the latest completed dividend period.
 
In 2007, the Board authorized 17,500.1 shares of perpetualNon-CumulativePreferred Stock, Series E (Series E Preferred Stock), and 5,000.1 shares of perpetualNon-CumulativePreferred Stock, Series F (Series F Preferred Stock), in connection with the APEX issuance. See Note 7 for further information on the APEX issuance. Under the stock purchase contracts, Group Inc. will issue on the relevant stock purchase dates (on or before June 1, 2013 and September 1, 2013 for Series E and Series F Preferred Stock, respectively) one share of Series E and Series F Preferred Stock to Goldman Sachs Capital II and III, respectively, for each $100,000 principal amount of subordinated debt held by these trusts. When issued, each share of Series E and Series F Preferred Stock will have a par value of $0.01 and a liquidation preference of $100,000 per share. Dividends on Series E Preferred Stock, if declared, will be payablesemi-annuallyat a fixed annual rate of 5.79% if the stock is issued prior to June 1, 2012 and quarterly thereafter, at a rate per annum equal to the greater of(i) three-monthLIBOR plus 0.77% and (ii) 4.00%. Dividends on Series F Preferred Stock, if declared, will be payable quarterly at a rate per annum equal tothree-monthLIBOR plus 0.77% if the stock is issued prior to September 1, 2012 and quarterly thereafter, at a rate per annum equal to the greater of(i) three-monthLIBOR plus 0.77% and (ii) 4.00%. The preferred stock may be redeemed at the option of the firm on the stock purchase dates or any day thereafter, subject to regulatory approval and certain covenant restrictions governing the firm’s ability to redeem or purchase the preferred stock without issuing common stock or other instruments withequity-likecharacteristics.
 
On April 19, 2010, the Board declared dividends of $231.77, $387.50, $247.22 and $247.22 per share of Series A Preferred Stock, Series B Preferred Stock, Series C Preferred Stock and Series D Preferred Stock, respectively, to be paid on May 10, 2010 to preferred shareholders of record on April 25, 2010. In addition, the Board declared a dividend of $2,500 per share of Series G Preferred Stock to be paid on May 10, 2010 to preferred shareholders of record on April 25, 2010.
 
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss) by type:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Currency translation adjustment, net of tax
 $(136) $(132)
Pension and postretirement liability adjustments, net of tax
  (311)  (317)
Net unrealized gains onavailable-for-salesecurities, net of tax (1)
  91   87 
         
Total accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax
 $(356) $(362)
         
 
 
  (1) Consists of net unrealized gains of $88 million and $84 million onavailable-for-salesecurities held by the firm’s insurance subsidiaries as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, and net unrealized gains of $3 million onavailable-for-salesecurities held by investees accounted for under the equity method as of both March 2010 and December 2009.

64


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 10.  Earnings Per Common Share
 
The computations of basic and diluted earnings per common share are set forth below:
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions, except
  per share amounts)
Numerator for basic and diluted EPS — net earnings applicable to common shareholders
 $3,296  $1,659 
         
Denominator for basic EPS — weighted average number of common shares
  546.0   477.4 
Effect of dilutive securities (1)
        
RSUs
  12.3   9.3 
Stock options and warrants
  31.7   2.5 
         
Dilutive potential common shares
  44.0   11.8 
         
Denominator for diluted EPS — weighted average number of common shares and dilutive potential common shares
  590.0   489.2 
         
Basic EPS (2)
 $6.02  $3.48 
Diluted EPS
  5.59   3.39 
 
 
  (1) The diluted EPS computations do not include the antidilutive effect of RSUs, stock options and warrants as follows:
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
 
Number of antidilutive RSUs and common shares underlying antidilutive stock options and warrants
  6.0   92.7 
         
 
  (2) Unvestedshare-basedpayment awards that havenon-forfeitablerights to dividends or dividend equivalents are treated as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per common share. The impact of applying this methodology was a reduction to basic earnings per common share of $0.02 for the three months ended March 2010. There was no impact to basic earnings per common share for the three months ended March 2009.

65


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 11.  Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
Goodwill
 
The following table sets forth the carrying value of the firm’s goodwill by operating segment, which is included in “Other assets” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Investment Banking
        
Underwriting
 $125  $125 
Trading and Principal Investments
        
FICC
  297   265 
Equities (1)
  2,389   2,389 
Principal Investments
  84   84 
Asset Management and Securities Services
        
Asset Management (2)
  563   563 
Securities Services
  117   117 
         
Total
 $3,575  $3,543 
         
 
 
  (1) Primarily related to SLK LLC (SLK).
 
  (2) Primarily related to The Ayco Company, L.P. (Ayco).

66


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
The following table sets forth the gross carrying amount, accumulated amortization and net carrying amount of the firm’s identifiable intangible assets:
 
           
    As of
    March
 December
    2010 2009
    (in millions)
 
Customer lists (1)
 Gross carrying amount $1,118  $1,117 
  Accumulated amortization  (488)  (472)
           
  Net carrying amount $630  $645 
           
Broadcast
 Gross carrying amount $560  $ 
royalties (2)
 Accumulated amortization  (15)   
           
  Net carrying amount $545  $ 
           
Commodities-related
 Gross carrying amount $553  $40 
intangibles (3)
 Accumulated amortization  (10)  (10)
           
  Net carrying amount $543  $30 
           
NYSE DMM rights
 Gross carrying amount $714  $714 
  Accumulated amortization  (304)  (294)
           
  Net carrying amount $410  $420 
           
Insurance-related
 Gross carrying amount $292  $292 
intangibles (4)
 Accumulated amortization  (140)  (142)
           
  Net carrying amount $152  $150 
           
Exchange-traded
 Gross carrying amount $138  $138 
fund (ETF) lead
 Accumulated amortization  (50)  (48)
           
market maker rights
 Net carrying amount $88  $90 
           
Other (5)
 Gross carrying amount $120  $130 
  Accumulated amortization  (80)  (88)
           
  Net carrying amount $40  $42 
           
Total
 Gross carrying amount $3,495  $2,431 
  Accumulated amortization  (1,087)  (1,054)
           
  Net carrying amount $2,408  $1,377 
           
 
  (1) Primarily includes the firm’s clearance and execution and NASDAQ customer lists related to SLK and financial counseling customer lists related to Ayco.
 
  (2) Represents television broadcast royalties held by a VIE consolidated upon adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17.
 
  (3) Primarily includes commodity-related customer contracts and relationships, permits and access rights acquired during the first quarter of 2010.
 
  (4) Primarily includes VOBA related to the firm’s insurance businesses.
 
  (5) Primarily includes marketing-related assets and other contractual rights.

67


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Substantially all of the firm’s identifiable intangible assets are considered to have finite lives and are amortized over their estimated lives. The weighted average remaining life of the firm’s identifiable intangible assets is approximately 11 years. “Depreciation and amortization” in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings includes amortization related to identifiable intangible assets of $44 million and $38 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively.
 
The estimated future amortization for existing identifiable intangible assets through 2015 is set forth below:
 
     
  As of
  March 2010
  (in millions)
Remainder of 2010
 $216 
2011
  282 
2012
  274 
2013
  264 
2014
  206 
2015
  185 
 
Note 12.  Other Assets and Other Liabilities
 
Other Assets
 
Other assets are generally less liquid,non-financialassets. The following table sets forth the firm’s other assets by type:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Property, leasehold improvements and equipment (1)(2)
 $12,322  $11,380 
Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets (3)
  5,983   4,920 
Income tax-related assets
  6,751   7,937 
Equity-methodinvestments (4)
  1,374   1,484 
Miscellaneous receivables and other
  3,894   3,747 
         
Total
 $30,324  $29,468 
         
 
 
  (1) Net of accumulated depreciation and amortization of $7.50 billion and $7.28 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (2) Includes $5.99 billion and $5.90 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, related to property, leasehold improvements and equipment that the firm uses in connection with its operations. The remainder is held by investment entities consolidated by the firm. The increase in property, leasehold improvements and equipment from December 2009 to March 2010 is primarily related to consolidated VIEs.
 
  (3) See Note 11 for further information regarding the firm’s goodwill and identifiable intangible assets.
 
  (4) Excludes investments of $3.85 billion and $2.95 billion accounted for at fair value under the fair value option as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, which are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. The increase in investments accounted for at fair value under the fair value option from December 2009 to March 2010 is primarily related to investments held by VIEs consolidated upon adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17.

68


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Other Liabilities
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s other liabilities and accrued expenses by type:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Compensation and benefits
 $6,497  $11,170 
Insurance-related liabilities (1)
  11,829   11,832 
Noncontrolling interests (2)
  984   960 
Income tax-related liabilities
  3,701   4,022 
Employee interests in consolidated funds
  466   416 
Subordinated liabilities issued by consolidated VIEs
  2,020 (3)  612 
Accrued expenses and other
  4,236   4,843 
         
Total
 $29,733  $33,855 
         
 
 
  (1) Insurance-related liabilities are set forth in the table below:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
 
Separate account liabilities
 $4,202  $4,186 
Liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims
  6,557   6,484 
Contract holder account balances
  814   874 
Reserves for guaranteed minimum death and income benefits
  256   288 
         
Total insurance-related liabilities
 $11,829  $11,832 
         
 
Separate account liabilities are supported by separate account assets, representing segregated contract holder funds under variable annuity and life insurance contracts. Separate account assets are included in “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
Liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims include liabilities arising from reinsurance provided by the firm to other insurers. The firm had a receivable of $1.37 billion and $1.29 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, related to such reinsurance contracts, which is reported in “Receivables from customers and counterparties” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. In addition, the firm has ceded risks to reinsurers related to certain of its liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims and had a receivable of $875 million and $870 million as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, related to such reinsurance contracts, which is reported in “Receivables from customers and counterparties” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. Contracts to cede risks to reinsurers do not relieve the firm from its obligations to contract holders. Liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims include $1.79 billion and $1.84 billion carried at fair value under the fair value option as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
Reserves for guaranteed minimum death and income benefits represent a liability for the expected value of guaranteed benefits in excess of projected annuity account balances. These reserves are based on total payments expected to be made less total fees expected to be assessed over the life of the contract.
 
  (2) Includes $616 million and $598 million related to consolidated investment funds as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (3) Includes $1.50 billion related to entities consolidated upon adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17.

69


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 13.  Transactions with Affiliated Funds
 
The firm has formed numerous nonconsolidated investment funds withthird-partyinvestors. The firm generally acts as the investment manager for these funds and, as such, is entitled to receive management fees and, in certain cases, advisory fees, incentive fees or overrides from these funds. These fees amounted to $553 million and $593 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively. As of March 2010 and December 2009, the fees receivable from these funds were $832 million and $1.04 billion, respectively. Additionally, the firm may invest alongside thethird-partyinvestors in certain funds. The aggregate carrying value of the firm’s interests in these funds was $13.68 billion and $13.84 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. In the ordinary course of business, the firm may also engage in other activities with these funds, including, among others, securities lending, trade execution, trading, custody, and acquisition and bridge financing. See Note 8 for the firm’s commitments related to these funds.
 
Note 14.  Income Taxes
 
The firm is subject to examination by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (IRS) and other taxing authorities in jurisdictions where the firm has significant business operations, such as the United Kingdom, Japan, Hong Kong, Korea and various states, such as New York. The tax years under examination vary by jurisdiction. The firm does not expect unrecognized tax benefits to change significantly during the twelve months subsequent to March 2010.
 
Below is a table of the earliest tax years that remain subject to examination by major jurisdiction:
 
     
  As of
Jurisdiction March 2010
U.S. Federal
  2005 (1)
New York State and City
  2004 (2)
United Kingdom
  2005 
Japan
  2005 (3)
Hong Kong
  2003 
Korea
  2003 
 
 
  (1) IRS examination of fiscal 2005, 2006 and 2007 began during 2008. IRS examination of fiscal 2003 and 2004 has been completed but the liabilities for those years are not yet final.
 
  (2) New York State and City examination of fiscal 2004, 2005 and 2006 began in 2008.
 
  (3) Japan National Tax Agency examination of fiscal 2005 through 2009 began during the first quarter of 2010.
 
All years subsequent to the above years remain open to examination by the taxing authorities. The firm believes that the liability for unrecognized tax benefits it has established is adequate in relation to the potential for additional assessments. The resolution of tax matters is not expected to have a material effect on the firm’s financial condition but may be material to the firm’s operating results for a particular period, depending, in part, upon the operating results for that period.

70


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 15.  Regulation and Capital Adequacy
 
The Federal Reserve Board is the primary U.S. regulator of Group Inc., a bank holding company and a financial holding company under the U.S. Bank Holding Company Act of 1956. As a bank holding company, the firm is subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve Board. The firm’s bank depository institution subsidiaries, including GS Bank USA, are subject to similar capital requirements. Under the Federal Reserve Board’s capital adequacy requirements and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action (PCA) that is applicable to GS Bank USA, the firm and its bank depository institution subsidiaries must meet specific capital requirements that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities and certainoff-balance-sheetitems as calculated under regulatory reporting practices. The firm and its bank depository institution subsidiaries’ capital amounts, as well as GS Bank USA’s PCA classification, are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.
 
Many of the firm’s subsidiaries, including Goldman, Sachs & Co. (GS&Co.) and the firm’s otherbroker-dealersubsidiaries, are subject to separate regulation and capital requirements as described below.
 
The following table sets forth information regarding Group Inc.’s capital ratios as of March 2010 calculated in accordance with the Federal Reserve Board’s regulatory capital requirements currently applicable to bank holding companies, which are based on the Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel I). These ratios are used by the Federal Reserve Board and other U.S. federal banking agencies in the supervisory review process, including the assessment of the firm’s capital adequacy.
 
     
  As of
  March 2010
  ($ in millions)
Tier 1 capital
 $68,472 
Tier 2 capital
  13,541 
Total capital
  82,013 
Risk-weightedassets
  455,790 
Tier 1 capital ratio
  15.0%
Total capital ratio
  18.0%
Tier 1 leverage ratio
  8.1%
 
Risk-WeightedAssets (RWAs) under the Federal Reserve Board’srisk-basedcapital guidelines are calculated based on the amount of market risk and credit risk. RWAs for market risk are determined by reference to the firm’s VaR models, supplemented by other measures to capture risks not reflected in the firm’s VaR models. Credit risk for on-balance sheet assets is based on the balance sheet value. For off-balance sheet exposures, including OTC derivatives and commitments, a credit equivalent amount is calculated based on the notional of each trade. All such assets and amounts are then assigned a risk weight depending on, among other things, whether the counterparty is a sovereign, bank or qualifying securities firm, or other entity (or if collateral is held, depending on the nature of the collateral).
 
The firm’s Tier 1 leverage ratio is defined as Tier 1 capital under Basel I divided by adjusted average total assets (which includes adjustments for disallowed goodwill and certain intangible assets).

71


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Federal Reserve Board regulations require bank holding companies to maintain a minimum Tier 1 capital ratio of 4% and a minimum total capital ratio of 8%. The required minimum Tier 1 capital ratio and total capital ratio in order to be considered a “well capitalized” bank holding company under the Federal Reserve Board guidelines are 6% and 10%, respectively. Bank holding companies may be expected to maintain ratios well above the minimum levels, depending upon their particular condition, risk profile and growth plans. The minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio is 3% for bank holding companies that have received the highest supervisory rating under Federal Reserve Board guidelines or that have implemented the Federal Reserve Board’srisk-basedcapital measure for market risk. Other bank holding companies must have a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio of 4%.
 
The firm is currently working to implement the requirements set out in the Revised Framework for the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel II) as applicable to it as a bank holding company. U.S. banking regulators have incorporated the Basel II framework into the existingrisk-basedcapital requirements by requiring that internationally active banking organizations, such as Group Inc., transition to Basel II over several years.
 
GS Bank USA, a New York State-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC), is regulated by the Federal Reserve Board and the New York State Banking Department (NYSBD) and is subject to minimum capital requirements that (subject to certain exceptions) are similar to those applicable to bank holding companies. GS Bank USA computes its capital ratios in accordance with the regulatory capital guidelines currently applicable to state member banks, which are based on Basel I as implemented by the Federal Reserve Board, for purposes of assessing the adequacy of its capital. In order to be considered a “well capitalized” depository institution under the Federal Reserve Board guidelines, GS Bank USA must maintain a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 6%, a total capital ratio of at least 10% and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 5%. In November 2008, the firm contributed subsidiaries into GS Bank USA. In connection with this contribution, GS Bank USA agreed with the Federal Reserve Board to minimum capital ratios in excess of these “well capitalized” levels. Accordingly, for a period of time, GS Bank USA is expected to maintain a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 8%, a total capital ratio of at least 11% and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 6%.
 
The following table sets forth information regarding GS Bank USA’s capital ratios under Basel I as implemented by the Federal Reserve Board, as of March 2010:
 
     
  As of
  March 2010
Tier 1 capital ratio
  17.5%
Total capital ratio
  22.4%
Tier 1 leverage ratio
  18.9%
 
GS Bank USA is currently working to implement the Basel II framework. Similar to the firm’s requirement as a bank holding company, GS Bank USA is required to transition to Basel II over the next several years.

72


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The deposits of GS Bank USA are insured by the FDIC to the extent provided by law. The Federal Reserve Board requires depository institutions to maintain cash reserves with a Federal Reserve Bank. The amount deposited by the firm’s depository institution subsidiaries held at the Federal Reserve Bank was approximately $16.53 billion and $27.43 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, which exceeded required reserve amounts by $15.77 billion and $25.86 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. GS Bank Europe, a wholly owned credit institution, is regulated by the Irish Financial Services Regulatory Authority and is subject to minimum capital requirements. As of March 2010 and December 2009, GS Bank USA and GS Bank Europe were both in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements.
 
Transactions between GS Bank USA and its subsidiaries and Group Inc. and its subsidiaries and affiliates (other than, generally, subsidiaries of GS Bank USA) are regulated by the Federal Reserve Board. These regulations generally limit the types and amounts of transactions (including loans to and borrowings from GS Bank USA) that may take place and generally require those transactions to be on an arms-length basis.
 
The firm’s U.S. regulatedbroker-dealersubsidiaries include GS&Co. and Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P. (GSEC). GS&Co. and GSEC are registeredU.S. broker-dealersand futures commission merchants subject toRule 15c3-1of the SEC and Rule 1.17 of the Commodity Futures Trading Commission, which specify uniform minimum net capital requirements, as defined, for their registrants, and also effectively require that a significant part of the registrants’ assets be kept in relatively liquid form. GS&Co. and GSEC have elected to compute their minimum capital requirements in accordance with the “Alternative Net Capital Requirement” as permitted byRule 15c3-1.As of March 2010, GS&Co. had regulatory net capital, as defined byRule 15c3-1,of $11.60 billion, which exceeded the amount required by $9.59 billion. As of March 2010, GSEC had regulatory net capital, as defined byRule 15c3-1,of $1.92 billion, which exceeded the amount required by $1.80 billion. In addition to its alternative minimum net capital requirements, GS&Co. is also required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1 billion and net capital in excess of $500 million in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E ofRule 15c3-1.GS&Co. is also required to notify the SEC in the event that its tentative net capital is less than $5 billion. As of March 2010 and December 2009, GS&Co. had tentative net capital and net capital in excess of both the minimum and the notification requirements.
 
The firm has U.S. insurance subsidiaries that are subject to state insurance regulation and oversight in the states in which they are domiciled and in the other states in which they are licensed. In addition, certain of the firm’s insurance subsidiaries outside of the U.S. are part of the Lloyd’s market (which is regulated by the U.K.’s Financial Services Authority (FSA)) and certain are regulated by the Bermuda Monetary Authority. The firm’s insurance subsidiaries were in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements as of March 2010 and December 2009.
 
The firm’s principalnon-U.S. regulatedsubsidiaries include Goldman Sachs International (GSI) and Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd. (GSJCL). GSI, the firm’s regulated U.K.broker-dealer,is subject to the capital requirements of the FSA. GSJCL, the firm’s regulated Japanesebroker-dealer,is subject to the capital requirements imposed by Japan’s Financial Services Agency. As of March 2010 and December 2009, GSI and GSJCL were in compliance with their local capital adequacy requirements. Certain othernon-U.S. subsidiariesof the firm are also subject to capital adequacy requirements promulgated by authorities of the countries in which they operate. As of March 2010 and December 2009, these subsidiaries were in compliance with their local capital adequacy requirements.

73


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The regulatory requirements referred to above restrict Group Inc.’s ability to withdraw capital from its regulated subsidiaries. In addition to limitations on the payment of dividends imposed by federal and state laws, the Federal Reserve Board, the FDIC and the NYSBD have authority to prohibit or to limit the payment of dividends by the banking organizations they supervise (including GS Bank USA) if, in the relevant regulator’s opinion, payment of a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice in the light of the financial condition of the banking organization.
 
Note 16.  Business Segments
 
In reporting to management, the firm’s operating results are categorized into the following three business segments: Investment Banking, Trading and Principal Investments, and Asset Management and Securities Services. See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of the firm’s Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 2009 for a discussion of the basis of presentation for the firm’s business segments.

74


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
Segment Operating Results
 
Management believes that the following information provides a reasonable representation of each segment’s contribution to consolidatedpre-taxearnings and total assets:
 
           
    As of or for the
    Three Months
    Ended March
    2010 2009
    (in millions)
 
Investment
 Net revenues $1,184  $823 
Banking
 Operating expenses  950   705 
           
  Pre-tax earnings $234  $118 
           
  Segment assets $1,541  $1,479 
           
Trading and
 Net revenues $10,250  $7,150 
Principal
 Operating expenses  5,565   4,873 
           
Investments
 Pre-tax earnings $4,685  $2,277 
           
  Segment assets $685,937  $706,647 
           
Asset Management
 Net revenues $1,341  $1,452 
and Securities
 Operating expenses  1,080   1,205 
           
Services
 Pre-tax earnings $261  $247 
           
  Segment assets $193,050  $217,164 
           
Total
 Net revenues (1)(2) $12,775  $9,425 
  Operating expenses (3)  7,616   6,796 
           
  Pre-taxearnings (4) $5,159  $2,629 
           
  Total assets $880,528  $925,290 
           
 
 
  (1) Net revenues include net interest income as set forth in the table below:
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
 
Investment Banking
 $  $ 
Trading and Principal Investments
  1,055   1,444 
Asset Management and Securities Services
  363   463 
         
Total net interest
 $1,418  $1,907 
         

75


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
  (2) Net revenues includenon-interestrevenues as set forth in the table below:
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
 
Investment banking fees
 $1,184  $823 
Equities commissions
  881   974 
Asset management and other fees
  978   989 
Trading and principal investments revenues
  8,314   4,732 
         
Totalnon-interestrevenues
 $11,357  $7,518 
         
 
Trading and principal investments revenues include $26 million and $6 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively, of realized gains on securities held within the firm’s insurance subsidiaries which are accounted for asavailable-for-sale.
 
  (3) Operating expenses include net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings of $21 million and $13 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively, that have not been allocated to the firm’s segments.
 
  (4) Pre-taxearnings include total depreciation and amortization as set forth in the table below:
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
 
Investment Banking
 $44  $37 
Trading and Principal Investments
  270   523 
Asset Management and Securities Services
  61   89 
         
Total depreciation and amortization
 $375  $649 
         
 
Geographic Information
 
Due to the highly integrated nature of international financial markets, the firm manages its businesses based on the profitability of the enterprise as a whole. Since a significant portion of the firm’s activities require cross-border coordination in order to facilitate the needs of the firm’s clients, the methodology for allocating the firm’s profitability to geographic regions is dependent on estimates and management judgment. Specifically, in interim periods, the firm allocates compensation and benefits to geographic regions based upon the firmwide compensation to net revenues ratio. In the fourth quarter when compensation by employee is finalized, compensation and benefits are allocated to the geographic regions based upon total actual compensation during the fiscal year. See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of the firm’s Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 2009 for a discussion of the method of allocating by geographic region.

76


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
The following table sets forth the total net revenues andpre-taxearnings of the firm by geographic region allocated based on the methodology referred to above, as well as the percentage of total net revenues andpre-taxearnings for each geographic region:
 
                 
  Three Months Ended March
  2010 2009
  ($ in millions)
Net revenues
                
Americas (1)
 $7,131   55% $6,473   69%
EMEA (2)
  3,905   31   1,886   20 
Asia
  1,739   14   1,066   11 
                 
Total net revenues
 $12,775   100% $9,425   100%
                 
Pre-taxearnings
                
Americas (1)
 $2,764   53% $2,145   N.M. 
EMEA (2)
  1,800   35   579   N.M. 
Asia
  616   12   (82)  N.M. 
Corporate (3)
  (21)  N.M.   (13)  N.M. 
                 
Totalpre-taxearnings
 $5,159   100% $2,629   100%
                 
 
 
  (1) Substantially all relates to the U.S.
 
  (2) EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa).
 
  (3) Consists of net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings.

77


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
(UNAUDITED)
 
 
Note 17.  Interest Income and Interest Expense
 
The following table sets forth the details of the firm’s interest income and interest expense:
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Interest income (1)
        
Deposits with banks
 $15  $22 
Securities borrowed, securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold
  79   551 
Trading assets, at fair value
  2,621   3,158 
Other interest (2)
  286   631 
         
Total interest income
 $3,001  $4,362 
         
Interest expense
        
Deposits
 $68  $150 
Securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
  136   545 
Trading liabilities, at fair value
  495   463 
Short-termborrowings (3)
  118   240 
Long-termborrowings (4)
  746   949 
Other interest (5)
  20   108 
         
Total interest expense
 $1,583  $2,455 
         
Net interest income
 $1,418  $1,907 
         
 
 
  (1) Interest income is recorded on an accrual basis based on contractual interest rates.
 
  (2) Primarily includes interest income on customer debit balances and other interest-earning assets.
 
  (3) Includes interest on unsecuredshort-termborrowings andshort-termother secured financings.
 
  (4) Includes interest on unsecuredlong-termborrowings andlong-termother secured financings.
 
  (5) Primarily includes interest expense on customer credit balances and other interest-bearing liabilities.

78


Table of Contents

 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
To the Board of Directors and the Shareholders of
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.:
 
We have reviewed the accompanying condensed consolidated statement of financial condition of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries (the Company) as of March 31, 2010, the related condensed consolidated statements of earnings for the three months ended March 31, 2010 and March 27, 2009, the condensed consolidated statement of changes in shareholders’ equity for the three months ended March 31, 2010, the condensed consolidated statements of cash flows for the three months ended March 31, 2010 and March 27, 2009, and the condensed consolidated statements of comprehensive income for the three months ended March 31, 2010 and March 27, 2009. These condensed consolidated interim financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management.
 
We conducted our review in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). A review of interim financial information consists principally of applying analytical procedures and making inquiries of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters. It is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the objective of which is the expression of an opinion regarding the financial statements taken as a whole. Accordingly, we do not express such an opinion.
 
Based on our review, we are not aware of any material modifications that should be made to the accompanying condensed consolidated interim financial statements for them to be in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
 
We previously audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated statement of financial condition as of December 31, 2009, and the related consolidated statements of earnings, changes in shareholders’ equity, cash flows and comprehensive income for the year then ended (not presented herein), and in our report dated February 26, 2010, we expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements. In our opinion, the information set forth in the accompanying condensed consolidated statement of financial condition as of December 31, 2009 and the condensed consolidated statement of changes in shareholders’ equity for the year ended December 31, 2009, is fairly stated in all material respects in relation to the consolidated financial statements from which it has been derived.
 
/s/PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
 
New York, New York
May 7, 2010

79


Table of Contents

 
STATISTICAL DISCLOSURES
 
Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
 
The following table sets forth a summary of consolidated average balances and interest rates for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009:
 
                         
  Three Months Ended March
  2010 2009
      Average
     Average
  Average
   rate
 Average
   rate
  balance Interest (annualized) balance Interest (annualized)
  (in millions, except rates)
 
Assets
                        
Deposits with banks
 $25,706  $15   0.24% $20,880  $22   0.42%
U.S. 
  19,941   11   0.22   18,422   13   0.28 
Non-U.S. 
  5,765   4   0.28   2,458   9   1.47 
Securities borrowed, securities purchased under agreements
to resell, at fair value, and federal funds sold
  352,607   79   0.09   355,278   551   0.62 
U.S. 
  242,394   (27)  (0.05)  264,440   161   0.24 
Non-U.S. 
  110,213   106   0.39   90,838   390   1.72 
Trading assets (1)(2)
  270,056   2,621   3.94   295,731   3,158   4.28 
U.S. 
  186,455   1,964   4.27   218,423   2,576   4.73 
Non-U.S. 
  83,601   657   3.19   77,308   582   3.02 
Other interest-earning assets (3)
  108,298   286   1.07   159,932   631   1.58 
U.S. 
  75,028   146   0.79   110,069   362   1.32 
Non-U.S. 
  33,270   140   1.71   49,863   269   2.16 
                         
Total interest-earning assets
  756,667   3,001   1.61   831,821   4,362   2.10 
Cash and due from banks
  2,690           3,259         
Other noninterest-earning assets (2)
  109,130           144,543         
                         
Total assets
 $868,487          $979,623         
                         
Liabilities
                        
Interest-bearing deposits
 $39,026  $68   0.71% $39,525  $150   1.52%
U.S. 
  32,336   63   0.79   34,268   136   1.59 
Non-U.S. 
  6,690   5   0.30   5,257   14   1.07 
Securities loaned and securities sold under agreements
to repurchase, at fair value
  149,691   136   0.37   187,292   545   1.17 
U.S. 
  107,259   55   0.21   136,737   149   0.44 
Non-U.S. 
  42,432   81   0.77   50,555   396   3.14 
Trading liabilities (1)(2)
  83,875   495   2.39   63,285   463   2.93 
U.S. 
  45,440   229   2.04   31,008   152   1.97 
Non-U.S. 
  38,435   266   2.81   32,277   311   3.86 
Commercial paper
  1,693   1   0.26   669   3   1.80 
U.S. 
  322      0.10   384   3   3.13 
Non-U.S. 
  1,371   1   0.30   285      0.27 
Other borrowings (4)(5)
  49,261   117   0.96   74,227   237   1.28 
U.S. 
  29,520   98   1.35   49,153   207   1.69 
Non-U.S. 
  19,741   19   0.39   25,074   30   0.48 
Long-termborrowings (5)(6)
  193,471   746   1.56   200,733   949   1.90 
U.S. 
  182,695   679   1.51   189,497   874   1.85 
Non-U.S. 
  10,776   67   2.52   11,236   75   2.68 
Other interest-bearing liabilities (7)
  189,072   20   0.04   226,534   108   0.19 
U.S. 
  143,894   (84)  (0.24)  158,849   (73)  (0.18)
Non-U.S. 
  45,178   104   0.93   67,685   181   1.07 
                         
Total interest-bearing liabilities
  706,089   1,583   0.91   792,265   2,455   1.24 
Noninterest-bearing deposits
  239           83         
Other noninterest-bearing liabilities (2)
  89,727           124,214         
                         
Total liabilities
  796,055           916,562         
                         
Shareholders’ equity
                        
Preferred stock
  6,957           16,495         
Common stock
  65,475           46,566         
                         
Total shareholders’ equity
  72,432           63,061         
Total liabilities, preferred stock and shareholders’ equity
 $868,487          $979,623         
                         
Interest rate spread
          0.70%          0.86%
Net interest income and net yield on interest-earning assets
     $1,418   0.76      $1,907   0.92 
U.S. 
      1,054   0.82       1,664   1.09 
Non-U.S. 
      364   0.63       243   0.44 
Percentage of interest-earning assets andinterest-bearingliabilities attributable tonon-U.S. operations(8)
                        
Assets
          30.77%          26.50%
Liabilities
          23.31           24.28 

80


Table of Contents

 
STATISTICAL DISCLOSURES
 
 
(1)  Consists of cash trading instruments, including equity securities and convertible debentures.
 
(2)  Derivative instruments are included in other noninterest-earning assets and other noninterest-bearing liabilities.
 
(3)  Primarily consists of cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes and receivables from customers and counterparties.
 
(4)  Consists ofshort-termother secured financings and unsecuredshort-termborrowings, excluding commercial paper.
 
(5)  Interest rates include the effects of interest rate swaps accounted for as hedges.
 
(6)  Consists oflong-termother secured financings and unsecuredlong-termborrowings.
 
(7)  Primarily consists of payables to customers and counterparties.
 
(8)  Assets, liabilities and interest are attributed to U.S. andnon-U.S. basedon the location of the legal entity in which the assets and liabilities are held.

81


Table of Contents

 
STATISTICAL DISCLOSURES
 
 
Ratios
 
The following table sets forth selected financial ratios:
 
         
  Three Months Ended March
  2010 2009
 
Annualized net earnings to average assets
  1.6%  0.7%
Annualized return on average common shareholders’ equity (1)
  20.1   14.3 
Annualized return on average total shareholders’ equity (2)
  19.1   11.5 
Total average equity to average assets
  8.3   6.4 
 
 
  (1) Based on annualized net earnings applicable to common shareholders divided by average monthly common shareholders’ equity.
 
  (2) Based on annualized net earnings divided by average monthly total shareholders’ equity.
 
Cross-border Outstandings
 
Cross-border outstandings are based upon the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council’s (FFIEC) regulatory guidelines for reporting cross-border risk. Claims include cash, receivables, securities purchased under agreements to resell, securities borrowed and cash trading instruments, but exclude derivative instruments and commitments. Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed are presented based on the domicile of the counterparty, without reduction for related securities collateral held.
 
The following tables set forth cross-border outstandings for each country in which cross-border outstandings exceed 0.75% of consolidated assets as of March 2010 and December 2009 in accordance with the FFIEC guidelines:
 
                 
  As of March 2010
  Banks Governments Other Total
  (in millions)
 
Country
                
United Kingdom
 $4,905  $4,693  $51,611  $61,209 
France
  18,929   3,838   6,153   28,920 
Japan
  15,027   155   6,511   21,693 
Germany
  7,878   5,951   2,723   16,552 
China
  8,899   755   4,702   14,356 
Cayman Islands
  1      10,703   10,704 
Ireland
  5,463   127   3,832   9,422 
Switzerland
  1,510   22   6,302   7,834 
Italy
  1,251   4,635   741   6,627 
 
                 
  As of December 2009
  Banks Governments Other Total
  (in millions)
 
Country
                
United Kingdom
 $3,276  $4,843  $52,342  $60,461 
Japan
  18,251   107   6,624   24,982 
France
  8,844   4,648   5,863   19,355 
Germany
  8,610   6,050   3,594   18,254 
China
  9,105   108   4,196   13,409 
Ireland
  5,633   20   1,815   7,468 

82


Table of Contents

Item 2:  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
 
INDEX
 
     
  Page
  No.
 
  84 
    
  85 
    
  87 
    
  88 
    
  97 
    
  98 
    
  108 
    
  109 
    
  116 
    
  118 
    
  123 
    
  124 
    
  128 
    
  136 
    
  137 

83


Table of Contents

 
Introduction
 
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc.) is a leading global investment banking, securities and investment management firm that provides a wide range of financial services to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments andhigh-net-worthindividuals. Founded in 1869, the firm is headquartered in New York and maintains offices in London, Frankfurt, Tokyo, Hong Kong and other major financial centers around the world.
 
Our activities are divided into three segments:
 
  • Investment Banking.  We provide a broad range of investment banking services to a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals.
 
  • Trading and Principal Investments.  We facilitate client transactions with a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals through market making in, trading of and investing in fixed income and equity products, currencies, commodities and derivatives on these products. We also take proprietary positions on certain of these products. In addition, we engage inmarket-makingactivities on equities and options exchanges, and we clear client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide. In connection with our merchant banking and other investing activities, we make principal investments directly and through funds that we raise and manage.
 
  • Asset Management and Securities Services.  We provide investment and wealth advisory services and offer investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and provide prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and tohigh-net-worthindividuals worldwide.
 
This Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations should be read in conjunction with our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009. References herein to our Annual Report onForm 10-Kare to our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009.
 
When we use the terms “Goldman Sachs,” “the firm,” “we,” “us” and “our,” we mean Group Inc., a Delaware corporation, and its consolidated subsidiaries.
 
All references to March 2010 and March 2009, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to our fiscal periods ended, or the dates, as the context requires, March 31, 2010 and March 27, 2009, respectively. Beginning with the fourth quarter of fiscal 2009, we changed our fiscal year-end from the last Friday of December to December 31. All references to December 2009, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to our fiscal year ended, or the date, as the context requires, December 31, 2009. All references to 2010, unless specifically stated otherwise, refer to our year ending, or the date, as the context requires, December 31, 2010.

84


Table of Contents

 
Executive Overview
 
Our diluted earnings per common share were $5.59 for the first quarter of 2010 compared with $3.39 for the first quarter of 2009. Annualized return on average common shareholders’ equity (ROE) (1)was 20.1% for the first quarter of 2010. Our Tier 1 capital ratio under Basel I (2)was 15.0% as of March 2010. Our Tier 1 common ratio under Basel I (3)was 12.4% as of March 2010.
 
Net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments were significantly higher compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting significantly improved results in Principal Investments, as well as higher net revenues in Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities (FICC) and Equities. In the first quarter of 2010, results in Principal Investments included a net gain of $760 million from corporate principal investments, partially offset by a loss of $222 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of Industrial and Commercial Bank of China Limited (ICBC) and a net loss of $34 million from real estate principal investments. In the first quarter of 2009, results in Principal Investments included net losses of $640 million from real estate principal investments and $621 million from corporate principal investments, as well as a loss of $151 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC. The increase in FICC reflected strength in the client franchise and included strong performances in credit products, mortgages and currencies, which were each significantly higher compared with the first quarter of 2009. Net revenues in interest rate products and commodities were also strong, although each was significantly lower compared with particularly strong results in the first quarter of 2009. During the first quarter of 2009, credit products included losses from corporate debt and private equity investments, and mortgages included a loss of approximately $800 million (excluding hedges) on commercial mortgage loans and securities. During the first quarter of 2010, FICC operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, increased volumes across several businesses, tighter bid/offer spreads and a decline in volatility levels. Net revenues in Equities for the first quarter of 2010 reflected strong net revenues in derivatives, which were significantly higher compared with the first quarter of 2009. In addition, results in principal strategies were positive compared with losses in the first quarter of 2009. Commissions were lower compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting generally lower market volumes. During the quarter, Equities operated in an environment largely characterized by an increase in global equity prices and a decline in volatility levels.
 
Net revenues in Investment Banking also increased compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting significantly higher net revenues in our Underwriting business, partially offset by lower net revenues in Financial Advisory. Net revenues in equity underwriting were significantly higher, primarily reflecting a significant increase inindustry-wideequity andequity-relatedofferings compared with a difficult first quarter of 2009. Net revenues in debt underwriting were also significantly higher, primarily reflecting an increase in leveraged finance activity. The decrease in Financial Advisory reflected a decline inindustry-widecompleted mergers and acquisitions. Our investment banking transaction backlog was essentially unchanged compared with the end of 2009.(4)
 
 
(1)  Annualized ROE is computed by dividing annualized net earnings applicable to common shareholders by average monthly common shareholders’ equity. See“— Resultsof Operations — Financial Overview” below for further information regarding our calculation of ROE.
 
(2)  As a bank holding company, we are subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements administered by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board). We are reporting our Tier 1 capital ratio calculated in accordance with the regulatory capital requirements currently applicable to bank holding companies, which are based on the Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel I). The Tier 1 capital ratio equals Tier 1 capital divided byrisk-weightedassets (RWAs). See “ — Equity Capital — Consolidated Capital Requirements” below for further information regarding our Tier 1 capital ratio.
 
(3)  The Tier 1 common ratio equals Tier 1 capital less preferred stock and junior subordinated debt issued to trusts, divided by RWAs. We believe that the Tier 1 common ratio is meaningful because it is one of the measures that we and investors use to assess capital adequacy. See“— EquityCapital — Capital Ratios and Metrics” below for further information regarding our Tier 1 common ratio.
 
(4)  Our investment banking transaction backlog represents an estimate of our future net revenues from investment banking transactions where we believe that future revenue realization is more likely than not.

85


Table of Contents

 
Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services decreased compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting lower net revenues in Securities Services. The decline in Securities Services primarily reflected tighter securities lending spreads, principally due to the impact of changes in the composition of securities lending customer balances, partially offset by the impact of higher average customer balances. Net revenues in Asset Management were essentially unchanged compared with the first quarter of 2009. During the first quarter of 2010, assets under management decreased $31 billion to $840 billion, due to $39 billion of net outflows, primarily reflecting outflows in money market assets, consistent with industry trends, partially offset by inflows in fixed income assets, and $8 billion of market appreciation, primarily in equity assets.
 
The accrual for compensation and benefits expenses was 43.0% of net revenues for the first quarter of 2010, down from 50.0% for the first quarter of 2009. The ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues for the first quarter of 2010 is our lowest ever first quarter ratio, 650 basis points lower than our historical reported first quarter average ratio of 49.5%.
 
In order to offset increases in share count resulting from employeeshare-basedcompensation, we repurchased 13.2 million shares of our common stock during the first quarter of 2010 at an average cost per share of $172.15, for a total cost of $2.27 billion. Including the effect of these share repurchases, common shareholders’ equity increased $2.23 billion to $65.99 billion during the quarter. In addition, book value per common share increased 4% during the quarter to $122.52 and tangible book value per common share(1)increased 3% during the quarter to $111.41.
 
Our business, by its nature, does not produce predictable earnings. Our results in any given period can be materially affected by conditions in global financial markets, economic conditions generally and other factors. For a further discussion of the factors that may affect our future operating results, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report onForm 10-K.
 
 
(1) Tangible common shareholders’ equity equals total shareholders’ equity less preferred stock, goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. Tangible book value per common share is computed by dividing tangible common shareholders’ equity by the number of common shares outstanding, including restricted stock units (RSUs) granted to employees with no future service requirements. We believe that tangible common shareholders’ equity and tangible book value per common share are meaningful because they are measures that we and investors use to assess capital adequacy. See“— EquityCapital — Capital Ratios and Metrics” below for further information regarding tangible common shareholders’ equity and tangible book value per common share.

86


Table of Contents

 
Business Environment
 
Global economic conditions generally improved during the first quarter of 2010 as real gross domestic product (GDP) increased in most economies. Global equity markets largely increased during the first quarter and volatility levels across fixed income and equity markets declined. The U.S. dollar appreciated against the Euro, the British pound and the Japanese yen. Investment banking activity generally declined during the first quarter, with significant declines inindustry-widecompleted mergers and acquisitions andindustry-wideequity andequity-relatedofferings.
 
In the U.S., real GDP increased during the first quarter, although at a slower pace than in the fourth quarter of 2009. The rate of unemployment declined slightly and consumer spending improved during the first quarter. Measures of core inflation continued to decline during the quarter, reflecting significant excess production capacity. The U.S. Federal Reserve maintained its federal funds rate at a target range of zero to 0.25% during the first quarter. The10-yearU.S. Treasury note yield ended the first quarter at 3.84%, essentially unchanged from the end of 2009. In equity markets, the NASDAQ Composite Index, the S&P 500 Index and the Dow Jones Industrial Average increased by 6%, 5% and 4%, respectively, during the first quarter.
 
In the Eurozone economies, real GDP appeared to increase during the first quarter, driven by an increase in industrial production. In addition, surveys of business confidence continued to improve. However, concerns about fiscal challenges in certain Eurozone economies intensified over the quarter, weighing on markets and economic growth in these economies. In addition, labor markets remained weak, with the rate of unemployment rising in most of the major economies. Although the rate of overall inflation increased moderately, measures of core inflation continued to fall during the first quarter. The European Central Bank kept its main refinancing operations rate unchanged at 1.00% and the Euro depreciated by 6% against the U.S. dollar. In the U.K., real GDP increased during the first quarter, partially driven by an increase in exports. The Bank of England maintained its official bank rate at 0.50% and the British pound depreciated by 6% against the U.S. dollar.Long-termgovernment bond yields in both the Eurozone and the U.K. decreased during the first quarter. The FTSE 100 Index, the DAX Index and the CAC 40 Index increased 5%, 3% and 1%, respectively, during the first quarter, while the Euro Stoxx 50 Index declined by 1% during the quarter.
 
In Japan, real GDP appeared to increase during the first quarter, primarily driven by a significant increase in exports. Government fiscal stimulus programs supported an increase in consumer spending during the quarter. Measures of core inflation generally remained negative. The Bank of Japan left its target overnight call rate unchanged at 0.10%, while the yield on10-yearJapanese government bonds increased during the quarter. The Japanese yen depreciated slightly against the U.S. dollar and the Nikkei 225 Index increased 5% during the first quarter.
 
In China, real GDP growth remained strong during the first quarter. Growth was driven by strong fixed investment spending and consumption. The rate of inflation increased during the quarter. The People’s Bank of China increased the reserve requirement ratio by 100 basis points during the quarter. The Chinese yuan remained essentially unchanged against the U.S. dollar and the Shanghai Composite Index decreased by 5% during the first quarter. In India, economic growth was strong, supported by continued growth in domestic demand. The Indian rupee appreciated by 4% against the U.S. dollar. The Hang Seng Index declined by 3% during the first quarter, while equity markets in Korea and India ended the quarter essentially unchanged.

87


Table of Contents

 
Critical Accounting Policies
 
Fair Value
 
The use of fair value to measure financial instruments, with related gains or losses generally recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in our condensed consolidated statements of earnings, is fundamental to our financial statements and our risk management processes and is our most critical accounting policy. The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (i.e., the exit price). Financial assets are marked to bid prices and financial liabilities are marked to offer prices. Fair value measurements do not include transaction costs.
 
Substantially all trading assets and trading liabilities are reflected in our condensed consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value. In determining fair value, we separate our trading assets, at fair value and trading liabilities, at fair value into two categories: cash instruments and derivative contracts, as set forth in the following table:
 
Trading Instruments by Category
(in millions)
 
                 
  As of March 2010 As of December 2009
  Trading
 Trading
 Trading
 Trading
  Assets, at
 Liabilities, at
 Assets, at
 Liabilities, at
  Fair Value Fair Value Fair Value Fair Value
Cash trading instruments
 $247,318  $86,220  $244,124  $72,117 
ICBC
  7,538 (1)     8,111 (1)   
SMFG
        933   893 (4)
Other principal investments
  14,006 (2)     13,981 (2)   
                 
Principal investments
  21,544      23,025   893 
                 
Cash instruments
  268,862   86,220   267,149   73,010 
Exchange-traded
  6,816   1,954   6,831   2,548 
Over-the-counter
  63,757   51,907   68,422   53,461 
                 
Derivative contracts
  70,573 (3)  53,861 (5)  75,253 (3)  56,009 (5)
                 
Total
 $339,435  $140,081  $342,402  $129,019 
                 
 
 
  (1) Includes interests of $4.76 billion and $5.13 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs. The fair value of our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, which trade on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong, includes the effect of foreign exchange revaluation for which we maintain an economic currency hedge.
 
  (2) The following table sets forth the principal investments (other than our investments in ICBC and Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, Inc. (SMFG)) included within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment:
 
                         
  As of March 2010 As of December 2009
  Corporate Real Estate Total Corporate Real Estate Total
  (in millions)
 
Private
 $9,960  $1,235  $11,195  $9,507  $1,325  $10,832 
Public
  2,758   53   2,811   3,091   58   3,149 
                         
Total
 $12,718  $1,288  $14,006  $12,598  $1,383  $13,981 
                         
 
  (3) Net of cash received pursuant to credit support agreements of $118.75 billion and $124.60 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (4) Represents an economic hedge on the shares of common stock underlying our investment in the convertible preferred stock of SMFG.
 
  (5) Net of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements of $14.50 billion and $14.74 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.

88


Table of Contents

Cash Instruments.  Cash instruments include cash trading instruments, public principal investments and private principal investments.
 
  • Cash Trading Instruments.  Our cash trading instruments (e.g., equity and debt securities) are generally valued using quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. The types of instruments valued based on quoted prices in active markets include U.S. andnon-U.S. governmentobligations, actively traded listed equities and certain money market instruments.
 
The types of instruments that trade in markets that are not considered to be active, but are valued based on quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency include commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits, most government agency obligations, most corporate debt securities, certainmortgage-backedloans and securities, certain bank loans and bridge loans, less liquid publicly listed equities, certain state and municipal obligations and certain money market instruments and loan commitments.
 
Certain cash trading instruments trade infrequently and therefore have little or no price transparency. Such instruments include private equity investments and real estate fund investments, certain bank loans and bridge loans (including certain mezzanine financing, leveraged loans arising from capital market transactions and other corporate bank debt), less liquid corporate debt securities and other debt obligations (including less liquid corporate bonds, distressed debt instruments and collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) backed by corporate obligations), less liquid mortgage whole loans and securities (backed by either commercial or residential real estate), and acquired portfolios of distressed loans. For these instruments, the transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. This valuation is adjusted only when changes to inputs and assumptions are corroborated by evidence such as transactions in similar instruments, completed or pendingthird-partytransactions in the underlying investment or comparable entities, subsequent rounds of financing, recapitalizations and other transactions across the capital structure, offerings in the equity or debt capital markets, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.
 
For positions that are not traded in active markets or are subject to transfer restrictions, valuations are adjusted to reflect illiquidityand/ornon-transferability.Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
  • Public Principal Investments.  Our public principal investments held within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment tend to be large, concentrated holdings resulting from initial public offerings or other corporate transactions, and are valued based on quoted market prices. For positions that are not traded in active markets or are subject to transfer restrictions, valuations are adjusted to reflect illiquidityand/ornon-transferability.Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC is valued using the quoted market price adjusted for transfer restrictions. Under the original transfer restrictions, the ICBC shares we held would have become free from transfer restrictions in equal installments on April 28, 2009 and October 20, 2009. During the quarter ended March 2009, the shares became subject to new supplemental transfer restrictions. Under these new supplemental transfer restrictions, on April 28, 2009, 20% of the ICBC shares that we held became free from transfer restrictions and we completed the disposition of these shares during the second quarter of 2009, while the remaining shares were subject to transfer restrictions until April 28, 2010. As of April 28, 2010, all of our remaining ICBC shares became free from transfer restrictions.

89


Table of Contents

Our investment in the convertible preferred stock of SMFG was valued using a model that is principally based on SMFG’s common stock price. During 2008, we convertedone-third of our SMFG preferred stock investment into SMFG common stock and delivered the common stock to close outone-third of our hedge position. During the first quarter of 2010, we converted the remaining two-thirds of our SMFG preferred stock investment into common stock and delivered the common stock to close out our remaining hedge position.
 
  • Private Principal Investments.  Our private principal investments held within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment include investments in private equity, debt and real estate, primarily held through investment funds. By their nature, these investments have little or no price transparency. We value such instruments initially at transaction price and adjust valuations when evidence is available to support such adjustments. Such evidence includes recentthird-partyinvestments or pending transactions,third-partyindependent appraisals, transactions in similar instruments, discounted cash flow techniques, valuation multiples and public comparables.
 
Derivative Contracts.  Derivative contracts can beexchange-tradedorover-the-counter(OTC). We generally valueexchange-tradedderivatives using models which calibrate tomarket-clearinglevels and eliminate timing differences between the closing price of theexchange-tradedderivatives and their underlying instruments.
 
OTC derivatives are valued using market transactions and other market evidence whenever possible, includingmarket-basedinputs to models, calibration tomarket-clearingtransactions, broker or dealer quotations, or other alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Where models are used, the selection of a particular model to value an OTC derivative depends upon the contractual terms of, and specific risks inherent in, the instrument, as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. We generally use similar models to value similar instruments. Valuation models require a variety of inputs, including contractual terms, market prices, yield curves, credit curves, measures of volatility, voluntary and involuntary prepayment rates, loss severity rates and correlations of such inputs. For OTC derivatives that trade in liquid markets, such as generic forwards, swaps and options, model inputs can generally be verified and model selection does not involve significant management judgment.
 
Certain OTC derivatives trade in less liquid markets with limited pricing information, and the determination of fair value for these derivatives is inherently more difficult. Where we do not have corroborating market evidence to support significant model inputs and cannot verify the model to market transactions, the transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. Subsequent to initial recognition, we only update valuation inputs when corroborated by evidence such as similar market transactions,third-partypricing servicesand/orbroker or dealer quotations, or other empirical market data. In circumstances where we cannot verify the model value to market transactions, it is possible that a different valuation model could produce a materially different estimate of fair value. See “— Derivatives” below for further information on our OTC derivatives.
 
When appropriate, valuations are adjusted for various factors such as liquidity, bid/offer spreads and credit considerations. Such adjustments are generally based on market evidence where available. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Controls Over Valuation of Financial Instruments.  A control infrastructure, independent of the trading and investing functions, is fundamental to ensuring that our financial instruments are appropriately valued atmarket-clearinglevels (i.e., exit prices) and that fair value measurements are reliable and consistently determined.

90


Table of Contents

We employ an oversight structure that includes appropriate segregation of duties. Senior management, independent of the trading and investing functions, is responsible for the oversight of control and valuation policies and for reporting the results of these policies to the Audit Committee of the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (Board). We seek to maintain the necessary resources to ensure that control functions are performed appropriately. We employ procedures for the approval of new transaction types and markets, price verification, review of daily profit and loss, and review of valuation models by personnel with appropriate technical knowledge of relevant products and markets. These procedures are performed by personnel independent of the trading and investing functions. For financial instruments where prices or valuations that require inputs are less observable, we employ, where possible, procedures that include comparisons with similar observable positions, analysis of actual to projected cash flows, comparisons with subsequent sales, reviews of valuations used for collateral management purposes and discussions with senior business leaders. See“— MarketRisk” and“— CreditRisk” below for a further discussion of how we manage the risks inherent in our trading and principal investing businesses.
 
Fair Value Hierarchy — Level 3.  The fair value hierarchy under Financial Accounting Standards Board Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) 820 prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The objective of a fair value measurement is to determine the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (i.e., the exit price). The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (level 1 measurements) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (level 3 measurements). Assets and liabilities are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement.
 
Instruments that trade infrequently and therefore have little or no price transparency are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. We determine which instruments are classified within level 3 based on the results of our price verification process. This process is performed by personnel independent of our trading and investing functions who corroborate valuations to external market data (e.g., quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations,third-partypricing vendors, recent trading activity and comparative analyses to similar instruments). Instruments with valuations which cannot be corroborated to external market data are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
When broker or dealer quotations orthird-partypricing vendors are used for valuation or price verification, greater priority is generally given to executable quotes. As part of our price verification process, valuations based on quotes are corroborated by comparison both to other quotes and to recent trading activity in the same or similar instruments. The number of quotes obtained varies by instrument and depends on the liquidity of the particular instrument. See Notes 2 and 3 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding fair value measurements.
 
Valuation Methodologies for Level 3 Assets.  Absent evidence to the contrary, instruments classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are initially valued at transaction price, which is considered to be the best initial estimate of fair value. Subsequent to the transaction date, we use other methodologies to determine fair value, which vary based on the type of instrument. Regardless of the methodology, valuation inputs and assumptions are only changed when corroborated by substantive evidence. Senior management in control functions, independent of the trading and investing functions, reviews all significant unrealized gains/losses, including the primary drivers of the change in value. Valuations are further corroborated by values realized upon sales of our level 3 assets. See Note 2 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor an overview of methodologies used to value our level 3 assets subsequent to the transaction date.

91


Table of Contents

Total level 3 assets were $45.15 billion and $46.48 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. The decrease in level 3 assets during the first quarter of 2010 primarily reflected sales and paydowns of loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, and bank loans and bridge loans, as well as net reductions in level 3 financial instruments as a result of the consolidations of certain VIEs.
 
The following table sets forth the fair values of financial assets classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy:
 
Level 3 Financial Assets at Fair Value
(in millions)
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
Equities and convertible debentures (1)
 $10,653  $11,871 
Bank loans and bridge loans (2)
  9,323   9,560 
Corporate debt securities (3)
  2,703   2,235 
State and municipal obligations
  870   1,114 
Other debt obligations
  1,487   2,235 
Mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities:
        
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
  4,070   4,620 
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
  2,131   1,880 
Loan portfolios (4)
  1,291   1,364 
         
Cash instruments
  32,528   34,879 
Derivative contracts
  12,123   11,596 
Securities purchased under agreements to resell
  268    
Receivables from customers and counterparties
  234    
         
Total level 3 assets at fair value
  45,153   46,475 
Level 3 assets for which we do not bear economic exposure (5)
  (2,640)  (3,127)
         
Level 3 assets for which we bear economic exposure
 $42,513  $43,348 
         
 
 
  (1) Substantially all consists of private equity investments and real estate fund investments. Real estate investments were $968 million and $1.23 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (2) Includes certain mezzanine financing, leveraged loans arising from capital market transactions and other corporate bank debt.
 
  (3) Includes $802 million and $741 million as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, of CDOs and collateralized loan obligations backed by corporate obligations.
 
  (4) Consists of acquired portfolios of distressed loans, primarily backed by commercial and residential real estate collateral.
 
  (5) We do not bear economic exposure to these level 3 assets as they are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.

92


Table of Contents

Loans and securities backed by residential real estate.  We securitize, underwrite and make markets in various types of residential mortgages, including prime, Alt-Aand subprime. At any point in time, we may use cash instruments as well as derivatives to manage our long or short risk position in residential real estate. The following table sets forth the fair value of our long positions in prime,Alt-A and subprime mortgage cash instruments:
 
Long Positions in Loans and Securities Backed by Residential Real Estate
(in millions)
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
Prime (1)
 $2,087  $2,483 
Alt-A
  1,419   1,761 
Subprime (2)
  2,151   2,460 
         
Total (3)
 $5,657  $6,704 
         
 
 
  (1) Excludes U.S. governmentagency-issuedcollateralized mortgage obligations of $10.02 billion and $6.33 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively. Also excludes U.S. governmentagency-issuedmortgage pass-through certificates.
 
  (2) Includes $350 million and $381 million of CDOs backed by subprime mortgages as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (3) Includes $2.13 billion and $1.88 billion of financial instruments (primarily loans andinvestment-gradesecurities, the majority of which were issued during 2006 and 2007) classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
 
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate.  We originate, securitize and syndicate fixed and floating rate commercial mortgages globally. At any point in time, we may use cash instruments as well as derivatives to manage our risk position in the commercial mortgage market. The following table sets forth the fair value of our long positions in loans and securities backed by commercial real estate by geographic region:
 
Long Positions in Loans and Securities Backed by
Commercial Real Estate by Geographic Region
(in millions)
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
Americas (1)
 $5,571  $5,157 
EMEA (2)
  660   1,032 
Asia
  10   14 
         
Total (3)
 $6,241 (4) $6,203 (5)
         
 
 
  (1) Substantially all relates to the U.S.
 
  (2) EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa).
 
  (3) Includes $4.07 billion and $4.62 billion of financial instruments classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (4) Comprised of loans of $4.20 billion and commercialmortgage-backedsecurities of $2.04 billion as of March 2010, of which $4.98 billion was floating rate and $1.26 billion was fixed rate.
 
  (5) Comprised of loans of $4.70 billion and commercialmortgage-backedsecurities of $1.50 billion as of December 2009, of which $5.68 billion was floating rate and $519 million was fixed rate.

93


Table of Contents

Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value.  In addition to trading assets, at fair value and trading liabilities, at fair value, we have elected to account for certain of our other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value under ASC815-15 and ASC 825-10(i.e., the fair value option). The primary reasons for electing the fair value option are to reflect economic events in earnings on a timely basis, to mitigate volatility in earnings from using different measurement attributes and to address simplification andcost-benefitconsiderations.
 
Such financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value include:
 
  • certain unsecuredshort-termborrowings, consisting of all promissory notes and commercial paper and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  • certain other secured financings, primarily transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales, debt raised through our William Street credit extension program and certain other nonrecourse financings;
 
  • certain unsecuredlong-termborrowings, including prepaid physical commodity transactions and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  • resale and repurchase agreements;
 
  • securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, consisting of our matched book and certain firm financing activities;
 
  • certain deposits issued by our bank subsidiaries, as well as securities held by GS Bank USA;
 
  • certain receivables from customers and counterparties, including certain margin loans, transfers of financial assets accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases and prepaid variable share forwards;
 
  • certain insurance and reinsurance contracts and certain guarantees;
 
  • certain subordinated liabilities issued by consolidated VIEs; and
 
  • in general, investments acquired after November 24, 2006, when the fair value option became available, where we have significant influence over the investee and would otherwise apply the equity method of accounting. In certain cases, we apply the equity method of accounting to new investments that are strategic in nature or closely related to our principal business activities, where we have a significant degree of involvement in the cash flows or operations of the investee, or wherecost-benefitconsiderations are less significant.

94


Table of Contents

Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
As a result of our acquisitions, principally SLK LLC (SLK) in 2000, The Ayco Company, L.P. (Ayco) in 2003 and our variable annuity and life insurance business in 2006, we have acquired goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. Goodwill is the cost of acquired companies in excess of the fair value of net assets, including identifiable intangible assets, at the acquisition date.
 
Goodwill.  We test the goodwill in each of our operating segments, which are components one level below our three business segments, for impairment at least annually, by comparing the estimated fair value of each operating segment with its estimated net book value. We derive the fair value of each of our operating segments based on valuation techniques we believe market participants would use for each segment (observable averageprice-to-earningsmultiples of our competitors in these businesses andprice-to-bookmultiples). We derive the net book value of our operating segments by estimating the amount of shareholders’ equity required to support the activities of each operating segment. Our last annual impairment test was performed during our 2009 fourth quarter and no impairment was identified.
 
The following table sets forth the carrying value of our goodwill by operating segment:
 
Goodwill by Operating Segment
(in millions)
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
Investment Banking
        
Underwriting
 $125  $125 
Trading and Principal Investments
        
FICC
  297   265 
Equities (1)
  2,389   2,389 
Principal Investments
  84   84 
Asset Management and Securities Services
        
Asset Management (2)
  563   563 
Securities Services
  117   117 
         
Total
 $3,575  $3,543 
         
 
 
  (1) Primarily related to SLK.
 
  (2) Primarily related to Ayco.
 
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets.  We amortize our identifiable intangible assets over their estimated lives or, in the case of insurance contracts, in proportion to estimated gross profits or premium revenues. Identifiable intangible assets are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable. An impairment loss, generally calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the sum of the estimated undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.

95


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the carrying value and range of estimated remaining lives of our identifiable intangible assets by major asset class:
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets by Asset Class
($ in millions)
 
             
  As of
 As of
  March 2010 December 2009
    Range of Estimated
  
  Carrying
 Remaining Lives
 Carrying
  Value (in years) Value
Customer lists (1)
 $630   1-15  $645 
Broadcast royalties (2)
  545   9    
Commodities-related intangibles (3)
  543   1-49   30 
New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) Designated Market Maker (DMM) rights
  410   12   420 
Insurance-related intangibles (4)
  152   6   150 
Exchange-tradedfund (ETF) lead market maker rights
  88   17   90 
Other (5)
  40   1-16   42 
             
Total
 $2,408      $1,377 
             
 
 
  (1) Primarily includes our clearance and execution and NASDAQ customer lists related to SLK and financial counseling customer lists related to Ayco.
 
  (2) Represents television broadcast royalties held by a VIE consolidated upon adoption of Accounting Standards Update (ASU)No. 2009-17.
 
  (3) Primarily includes commodity-related customer contracts and relationships, permits and access rights acquired during the first quarter of 2010.
 
  (4) Primarily includes the value of business acquired related to our insurance businesses.
 
  (5) Primarily includes marketing-related assets and other contractual rights.
 
 
A prolonged period of market weakness could adversely impact our businesses and impair the value of our identifiable intangible assets. In addition, certain events could indicate a potential impairment of our identifiable intangible assets, including (i) changes in trading volumes or market structure that could adversely affect our exchange-basedmarket-makingbusinesses (see discussion below), (ii) an adverse action or assessment by a regulator, (iii) adverse actual experience on the contracts in our variable annuity and life insurance business, (iv) decreases in cash receipts from television broadcast royalties or (v) decreases in revenues from commodity-related customer contracts and relationships.
 
In October 2008, the SEC approved the NYSE’s proposal to create a new market model and redefine the role of NYSE DMMs. In June 2009, the NYSE successfully completed the rollout of new systems architecture that further reduces order completion time, which enables the NYSE to offer competitive execution speeds, while continuing to incorporate the price discovery provided by DMMs. Following solid performance during the first half of 2009, our DMM business has been adversely impacted primarily by the lack of timely market data in the internal order/execution system of the NYSE (which, at times, results in DMMs making markets without real-time price information) and to a lesser extent, by lower trading volumes and lower volatility. In 2010, the NYSE is expected to address this market data issue. There can be no assurance that changes in these factors will result in sufficient cash flows to avoid impairment of our NYSE DMM rights in the future. In accordance with the requirements of ASC 360, we will be closely monitoring the performance of our DMM business to determine whether an impairment loss is required in the future. As of March 2010, the carrying value of our NYSE DMM rights was $410 million. To the extent that there were to be an impairment in the future, it would result in a significant writedown in the carrying value of these DMM rights.

96


Table of Contents

 
Use of Estimates
 
The use of generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make certain estimates and assumptions. In addition to the estimates we make in connection with fair value measurements, the accounting for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, and discretionary compensation accruals, the use of estimates and assumptions is also important in determining provisions for potential losses that may arise from litigation and regulatory proceedings and tax audits.
 
A substantial portion of our compensation and benefits represents discretionary compensation, which is finalized at year-end. We believe the most appropriate way to allocate estimated annual discretionary compensation among interim periods is in proportion to the net revenues earned in such periods. In addition to the level of net revenues, our overall compensation expense in any given year is also influenced by, among other factors, prevailing labor markets, business mix, the structure of ourshare-basedcompensation programs and the external environment. Our ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues was 43.0% for the first quarter of 2010 compared with 50.0% for the first quarter of 2009.
 
We estimate and provide for potential losses that may arise out of litigation and regulatory proceedings to the extent that such losses are probable and can be reasonably estimated. In accounting for income taxes, we estimate and provide for potential liabilities that may arise out of tax audits to the extent that uncertain tax positions fail to meet the recognition standard under ASC 740. See Note 2 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding accounting for income taxes.
 
Significant judgment is required in making these estimates and our final liabilities may ultimately be materially different. Our total estimated liability in respect of litigation and regulatory proceedings is determined on acase-by-casebasis and represents an estimate of probable losses after considering, among other factors, the progress of each case or proceeding, our experience and the experience of others in similar cases or proceedings, and the opinions and views of legal counsel. Given the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of our litigation and regulatory matters, particularly in cases or proceedings in which substantial or indeterminate damages or fines are sought, we cannot estimate losses or ranges of losses for cases or proceedings where there is only a reasonable possibility that a loss may be incurred. See“— LegalProceedings” in Part I, Item 3 of our Annual Report onForm 10-K,and in Part II, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor information on our judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings.

97


Table of Contents

 
Results of Operations
 
The composition of our net revenues has varied over time as financial markets and the scope of our operations have changed. The composition of net revenues can also vary over the shorter term due to fluctuations in U.S. and global economic and market conditions. See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor a further discussion of the impact of economic and market conditions on our results of operations.
 
Financial Overview
 
The following table sets forth an overview of our financial results:
 
Financial Overview
($ in millions, except per share amounts)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
Net revenues
 $12,775  $9,425 
Pre-taxearnings
  5,159   2,629 
Net earnings
  3,456   1,814 
Net earnings applicable to common shareholders
  3,296   1,659 
Diluted earnings per common share
  5.59   3.39 
Annualized return on average common shareholders’ equity (1)
  20.1%  14.3%
 
 
  (1) Annualized ROE is computed by dividing annualized net earnings applicable to common shareholders by average monthly common shareholders’ equity. The following table sets forth our average common shareholders’ equity:
 
         
  Average for the
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
 
Total shareholders’ equity
 $72,432  $63,061 
Preferred stock
  (6,957)  (16,495)
         
Common shareholders’ equity
 $65,475  $46,566 
         

98


Table of Contents

Net Revenues
 
Three Months Ended March 2010 versus March 2009.  Our net revenues were $12.78 billion for the first quarter of 2010, an increase of 36% compared with the first quarter of 2009, primarily reflecting significantly higher net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments. The increase in Trading and Principal Investments reflected significantly improved results in Principal Investments, as well as higher net revenues in FICC and Equities. In the first quarter of 2010, results in Principal Investments included a net gain of $760 million from corporate principal investments, partially offset by a loss of $222 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC and a net loss of $34 million from real estate principal investments. In the first quarter of 2009, results in Principal Investments included net losses of $640 million from real estate principal investments and $621 million from corporate principal investments, as well as a loss of $151 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC. The increase in FICC reflected strength in the client franchise and included strong performances in credit products, mortgages and currencies, which were each significantly higher compared with the first quarter of 2009. Net revenues in interest rate products and commodities were also strong, although each was significantly lower compared with particularly strong results in the first quarter of 2009. During the first quarter of 2009, credit products included losses from corporate debt and private equity investments, and mortgages included a loss of approximately $800 million (excluding hedges) on commercial mortgage loans and securities. During the first quarter of 2010, FICC operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, increased volumes across several businesses, tighter bid/offer spreads and a decline in volatility levels. Net revenues in Equities for the first quarter of 2010 reflected strong net revenues in derivatives, which were significantly higher compared with the first quarter of 2009. In addition, results in principal strategies were positive compared with losses in the first quarter of 2009. Commissions were lower compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting generally lower market volumes. During the quarter, Equities operated in an environment largely characterized by an increase in global equity prices and a decline in volatility levels.
 
Net revenues in Investment Banking also increased compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting significantly higher net revenues in our Underwriting business, partially offset by lower net revenues in Financial Advisory. Net revenues in equity underwriting were significantly higher, primarily reflecting a significant increase inindustry-wideequity andequity-relatedofferings compared with a difficult first quarter of 2009. Net revenues in debt underwriting were also significantly higher, primarily reflecting an increase in leveraged finance activity. The decrease in Financial Advisory reflected a decline inindustry-widecompleted mergers and acquisitions.
 
Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services decreased compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting lower net revenues in Securities Services. The decline in Securities Services primarily reflected tighter securities lending spreads, principally due to the impact of changes in the composition of securities lending customer balances, partially offset by the impact of higher average customer balances. Net revenues in Asset Management were essentially unchanged compared with the first quarter of 2009. During the first quarter of 2010, assets under management decreased $31 billion to $840 billion, due to $39 billion of net outflows, primarily reflecting outflows in money market assets, consistent with industry trends, partially offset by inflows in fixed income assets, and $8 billion of market appreciation, primarily in equity assets.

99


Table of Contents

Operating Expenses
 
Our operating expenses are primarily influenced by compensation, headcount and levels of business activity. Compensation and benefits expenses includes salaries, estimated year-end discretionary compensation, amortization of equity awards and other items such as payroll taxes, benefits and severance costs. Discretionary compensation is significantly impacted by, among other factors, the level of net revenues, prevailing labor markets, business mix, the structure of ourshare-basedcompensation programs and the external environment. Our ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues was 43.0% for the first quarter of 2010 compared with 50.0% for the first quarter of 2009. The ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues for the first quarter of 2010 is our lowest ever first quarter ratio, 650 basis points lower than our historical reported first quarter average ratio of 49.5%.
 
On April 8, 2010, the United Kingdom enacted legislation that imposes anon-deductible50% tax on certain financial institutions in respect of discretionary bonuses in excess of £25,000 awarded under arrangements made between December 9, 2009 and April 5, 2010 to “relevant banking employees.” Our current estimate, based on our understanding of the enacted legislation, of the total amount of tax expected to be paid is in excess of $600 million. We are currently engaged in discussions with HM Revenue and Customs regarding the legislation. Depending on the outcome of those discussions the expected tax to be paid may change. The tax will be recognized in earnings in the second quarter of 2010.
 
The following table sets forth our operating expenses and total staff:
 
Operating Expenses and Total Staff
($ in millions)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
Compensation and benefits
 $5,493  $4,712 
         
Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees
  562   536 
Market development
  110   68 
Communications and technology
  176   173 
Depreciation and amortization
  372   549 
Occupancy
  256   241 
Professional fees
  182   135 
Other expenses
  465   382 
         
Totalnon-compensationexpenses
  2,123   2,084 
         
Total operating expenses
 $7,616  $6,796 
         
Total staff at period end (1)
  33,100   31,600 
Total staff at period end including consolidated entities held for investment purposes (2)
  38,500   35,500 
 
 
  (1) Includes employees, consultants and temporary staff.
 
  (2) Compensation and benefits andnon-compensationexpenses related to consolidated entities held for investment purposes are included in their respective line items in the condensed consolidated statements of earnings. Consolidated entities held for investment purposes are entities that are held strictly for capital appreciation, have a defined exit strategy and are engaged in activities that are not closely related to our principal businesses.

100


Table of Contents

Three Months Ended March 2010 versus March 2009.  Operating expenses of $7.62 billion for the first quarter of 2010 increased 12% compared with the first quarter of 2009. The accrual for compensation and benefits expenses (including salaries, estimated year-end discretionary compensation, amortization of equity awards and other items such as payroll taxes, benefits and severance costs) was $5.49 billion for the first quarter of 2010. The ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues was 43.0% for the first quarter of 2010, down from 50.0% for the first quarter of 2009. Total staff increased 2% during the quarter. Total staff including consolidated entities held for investment purposes increased 6% during the quarter, primarily due to the consolidation of certain investment entities during the first quarter of 2010 as a result of our adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17,“Consolidations (Topic 810) — Improvements to Financial Reporting by Enterprises Involved with Variable Interest Entities” on January 1, 2010.
 
Non-compensationexpenses of $2.12 billion increased 2% compared with the first quarter of 2009. The increase compared with the first quarter of 2009 primarily reflected higher levels of business activity, as well as the impact of charitable contributions of $40 million and net provisions for litigation and regulatory proceedings of $21 million during the first quarter of 2010. These increases were partially offset by decreased depreciation and amortization expenses, due to the impact of significantly higher real estate impairment charges in the first quarter of 2009 related to consolidated entities held for investment purposes. These real estate impairment charges, which were measured based on discounted cash flow analysis, were included in our Trading and Principal Investments segment and reflected weakness in the commercial real estate markets, particularly in Asia.
 
Provision for Taxes
 
The effective income tax rate for the first quarter of 2010 was 33.0%, up slightly from 32.5% for fiscal year 2009.
 
Effective January 1, 2010, the rules related to the deferral of U.S. tax on certainnon-repatriatedactive financing income expired. This change did not have a material effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows for the first quarter of 2010 and we do not expect this change to have a material effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows for the remainder of 2010.

101


Table of Contents

Segment Operating Results
 
The following table sets forth the net revenues, operating expenses andpre-taxearnings of our segments:
 
Segment Operating Results
(in millions)
 
           
    Three Months
    Ended March
    2010 2009
 
Investment
 Net revenues $1,184  $823 
Banking
 Operating expenses  950   705 
           
  Pre-tax earnings $234  $118 
           
Trading and Principal
 Net revenues $10,250  $7,150 
Investments
 Operating expenses  5,565   4,873 
           
  Pre-taxearnings $4,685  $2,277 
           
Asset Management and
 Net revenues $1,341  $1,452 
Securities Services
 Operating expenses  1,080   1,205 
           
  Pre-tax earnings $261  $247 
           
Total
 Net revenues $12,775  $9,425 
  Operating expenses (1)  7,616   6,796 
           
  Pre-taxearnings $5,159  $2,629 
           
 
 
  (1) Operating expenses include net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings of $21 million and $13 million for the three months ended March 2010 and March 2009, respectively, that have not been allocated to our segments.
 
 
Net revenues in our segments include allocations of interest income and interest expense to specific securities, commodities and other positions in relation to the cash generated by, or funding requirements of, such underlying positions. See Note 16 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding our business segments.
 
The cost drivers of Goldman Sachs taken as a whole — compensation, headcount and levels of business activity — are broadly similar in each of our business segments. Compensation and benefits expenses within our segments reflect, among other factors, the overall performance of Goldman Sachs as well as the performance of individual business units. Consequently,pre-taxmargins in one segment of our business may be significantly affected by the performance of our other business segments. A discussion of segment operating results follows.

102


Table of Contents

Investment Banking
 
Our Investment Banking segment is divided into two components:
 
  • Financial Advisory.  Financial Advisory includes advisory assignments with respect to mergers and acquisitions, divestitures, corporate defense activities, restructurings andspin-offs.
 
  • Underwriting.  Underwriting includes public offerings and private placements of a wide range of securities and other financial instruments.
 
The following table sets forth the operating results of our Investment Banking segment:
 
Investment Banking Operating Results
(in millions)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
Financial Advisory
 $464  $527 
         
Equity underwriting
  371   48 
Debt underwriting
  349   248 
         
Total Underwriting
  720   296 
         
Total net revenues
  1,184   823 
Operating expenses
  950   705 
         
Pre-taxearnings
 $234  $118 
         
 
 
The following table sets forth our financial advisory and underwriting transaction volumes:
 
Goldman Sachs Global Investment Banking Volumes(1)
(in billions)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
Announced mergers and acquisitions (2)
 $183  $201 
Completed mergers and acquisitions (2)
  113   193 
Equity andequity-relatedofferings (3)
  14   2 
Debt offerings (4)
  60   69 
 
 
  (1) Announced and completed mergers and acquisitions volumes are based on full credit to each of the advisors in a transaction. Equity andequity-relatedofferings and debt offerings are based on full credit for single book managers and equal credit for joint book managers. Transaction volumes may not be indicative of net revenues in a given period. In addition, transaction volumes for prior periods may vary from amounts previously reported due to the subsequent withdrawal or a change in the value of a transaction.
 
  (2) Source: Dealogic.
 
  (3) Source: Thomson Reuters. Includes Rule 144A and public common stock offerings, convertible offerings and rights offerings.
 
  (4) Source: Thomson Reuters. Includesnon-convertiblepreferred stock,mortgage-backedsecurities,asset-backedsecurities and taxable municipal debt. Includes publicly registered and Rule 144A issues. Excludes leveraged loans.

103


Table of Contents

Three Months Ended March 2010 versus March 2009.  Net revenues in Investment Banking of $1.18 billion increased 44% compared with the first quarter of 2009.
 
Net revenues in Financial Advisory of $464 million decreased 12% compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting a decline inindustry-widecompleted mergers and acquisitions. Net revenues in our Underwriting business of $720 million were more than double the amount in the first quarter of 2009. Net revenues in equity underwriting were significantly higher, primarily reflecting a significant increase inindustry-wideequity andequity-relatedofferings compared with a difficult first quarter of 2009. Net revenues in debt underwriting were also significantly higher, primarily reflecting an increase in leveraged finance activity. Our investment banking transaction backlog was essentially unchanged compared with the end of 2009.(1)
 
Operating expenses of $950 million for the first quarter of 2010 increased 35% compared with the first quarter of 2009, primarily due to increased compensation and benefits expenses, resulting from higher net revenues.Pre-taxearnings of $234 million in the first quarter of 2010 increased 98% compared with the first quarter of 2009.
 
Trading and Principal Investments
 
Our Trading and Principal Investments segment is divided into three components:
 
  • FICC.  We make markets in and trade interest rate and credit products,mortgage-relatedsecurities and loan products and otherasset-backedinstruments, currencies and commodities, structure and enter into a wide variety of derivative transactions, and engage in proprietary trading and investing.
 
  • Equities.  We make markets in and trade equities andequity-relatedproducts, structure and enter into equity derivative transactions and engage in proprietary trading. We generate commissions from executing and clearing client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide through our Equities client franchise and clearing activities. We also engage in exchange-basedmarket-makingactivities and in insurance activities.
 
  • Principal Investments.  We make real estate and corporate principal investments, including our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC. We generate net revenues from returns on these investments and from the increased share of the income and gains derived from our merchant banking funds when the return on a fund’s investments over the life of the fund exceeds certain threshold returns (typically referred to as an override).
 
Substantially all of our inventory ismarked-to-marketdaily and, therefore, its value and our net revenues are subject to fluctuations based on market movements. In addition, net revenues derived from our principal investments, including those in privately held concerns and in real estate, may fluctuate significantly depending on the revaluation of these investments in any given period. We also regularly enter into large transactions as part of our trading businesses. The number and size of such transactions may affect our results of operations in a given period.
 
Net revenues from Principal Investments do not include management fees generated from our merchant banking funds. These management fees are included in the net revenues of the Asset Management and Securities Services segment.
 
 
(1) Our investment banking transaction backlog represents an estimate of our future net revenues from investment banking transactions where we believe that future revenue realization is more likely than not.
     

104


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the operating results of our Trading and Principal Investments segment:
 
Trading and Principal Investments Operating Results
(in millions)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
FICC
 $7,386  $6,557 
         
Equities trading
  1,473   1,027 
Equities commissions
  881   974 
         
Total Equities
  2,354   2,001 
         
ICBC
  (222)  (151)
         
Gross gains
  1,147   672 
Gross losses
  (421)  (1,933)
         
Net other corporate and real estate investments
  726   (1,261)
Overrides
  6   4 
         
         
Total Principal Investments
  510   (1,408)
         
Total net revenues
  10,250   7,150 
Operating expenses
  5,565   4,873 
         
Pre-taxearnings
 $4,685  $2,277 
         
 
 
Three Months Ended March 2010 versus March 2009.  Net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments of $10.25 billion increased 43% compared with the first quarter of 2009.
 
Net revenues in FICC of $7.39 billion increased 13% compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting strength in the client franchise. These results reflected strong performances in credit products, mortgages and currencies, which were each significantly higher compared with the first quarter of 2009. Net revenues in interest rate products and commodities were also strong, although each was significantly lower compared with particularly strong results in the first quarter of 2009. During the first quarter of 2009, credit products included losses from corporate debt and private equity investments, and mortgages included a loss of approximately $800 million (excluding hedges) on commercial mortgage loans and securities. During the first quarter of 2010, FICC operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, increased volumes across several businesses, tighter bid/offer spreads and a decline in volatility levels.
 
Net revenues in Equities of $2.35 billion increased 18% compared with the first quarter of 2009. These results reflected strong net revenues in derivatives, which were significantly higher compared with the first quarter of 2009. In addition, results in principal strategies were positive compared with losses in the first quarter of 2009. Commissions were lower compared with the first quarter of 2009, reflecting generally lower market volumes. During the quarter, Equities operated in an environment largely characterized by an increase in global equity prices and a decline in volatility levels.
 
Principal Investments recorded net revenues of $510 million for the first quarter of 2010. These results included a net gain of $760 million from corporate principal investments, partially offset by a loss of $222 million related to the firm’s investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC and a net loss of $34 million from real estate principal investments. In the first quarter of 2009, results in Principal Investments included net losses of $640 million from real estate principal investments and $621 million from corporate principal investments, as well as a loss of $151 million related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC.

105


Table of Contents

Operating expenses of $5.57 billion for the first quarter of 2010 increased 14% compared with the first quarter of 2009, due to increased compensation and benefits expenses, resulting from higher net revenues, partially offset by decreased depreciation and amortization expenses, due to the impact of significantly higher real estate impairment charges in the first quarter of 2009 related to consolidated entities held for investment purposes.Pre-taxearnings were $4.69 billion in the first quarter of 2010 compared with $2.28 billion in the first quarter of 2009.
 
Asset Management and Securities Services
 
Our Asset Management and Securities Services segment is divided into two components:
 
  • Asset Management.  Asset Management provides investment and wealth advisory services and offers investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and primarily generates revenues in the form of management and incentive fees.
 
  • Securities Services.  Securities Services provides prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and tohigh-net-worthindividuals worldwide, and generates revenues primarily in the form of interest rate spreads or fees.
 
Assets under management typically generate fees as a percentage of asset value, which is affected by investment performance and by inflows and redemptions. The fees that we charge vary by asset class, as do our related expenses. In certain circumstances, we are also entitled to receive incentive fees based on a percentage of a fund’s return or when the return on assets under management exceeds specified benchmark returns or other performance targets. Incentive fees are recognized when the performance period ends (in most cases, on December 31) and they are no longer subject to adjustment.
 
The following table sets forth the operating results of our Asset Management and Securities Services segment:
 
Asset Management and Securities Services Operating Results
(in millions)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March
  2010 2009
Management and other fees
 $926  $931 
Incentive fees
  20   18 
         
Total Asset Management
  946   949 
Securities Services
  395   503 
         
Total net revenues
  1,341   1,452 
Operating expenses
  1,080   1,205 
         
Pre-taxearnings
 $261  $247 
         

106


Table of Contents

Assets under management include assets in our mutual funds, alternative investment funds and separately managed accounts for institutional and individual investors. Substantially all assets under management are valued as of calendar month-end. Assets under management do not include:
 
  • assets in brokerage accounts that generate commissions,mark-ups and spreads based on transactional activity;
 
  • our own investments in funds that we manage; or
 
  • interest-bearing deposits held through our bank depository institution subsidiaries.
 
The following table sets forth our assets under management by asset class:
 
Assets Under Management by Asset Class
(in billions)
 
                 
  As of
  March 31, December 31,
 November 30,
  2010 2009 2009 2008
Alternative investments (1)
 $147  $141  $146  $146 
Equity
  150   101   146   112 
Fixed income
  324   248   315   248 
                 
Totalnon-moneymarket assets
  621   490   607   506 
Money markets
  219   281   264   273 
                 
Total assets under management
 $840  $771  $871  $779 
                 
 
 
  (1) Primarily includes hedge funds, private equity, real estate, currencies, commodities and asset allocation strategies.
 
 
The following table sets forth a summary of the changes in our assets under management:
 
Changes in Assets Under Management
(in billions)
 
         
  Three Months
  Ended March 31,
  2010 2009
Balance, beginning of period
 $871  $798 
         
Net inflows/(outflows)
        
Alternative investments
  1   (2)
Equity
  (2)  (1)
Fixed income
  7   (3)
         
Totalnon-moneymarket net inflows/(outflows)
  6   (6)
Money markets
  (45)  (5)
         
Total net inflows/(outflows)
  (39)  (11)
         
Net market appreciation/(depreciation)
  8   (16)
         
Balance, end of period
 $840  $771 
         

107


Table of Contents

Three Months Ended March 2010 versus March 2009.  Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services of $1.34 billion decreased 8% compared with the first quarter of 2009.
 
Asset Management net revenues of $946 million were essentially unchanged compared with the first quarter of 2009. During the first quarter of 2010, assets under management decreased $31 billion to $840 billion, due to $39 billion of net outflows, primarily reflecting outflows in money market assets, consistent with industry trends, partially offset by inflows in fixed income assets, and $8 billion of market appreciation, primarily in equity assets.
 
Securities Services net revenues of $395 million decreased 21% compared with the first quarter of 2009. The decrease in net revenues primarily reflected tighter securities lending spreads, principally due to the impact of changes in the composition of securities lending customer balances, partially offset by the impact of higher average customer balances.
 
Operating expenses of $1.08 billion for the first quarter of 2010 decreased 10% compared with the first quarter of 2009, due to decreased compensation and benefits expenses, primarily resulting from lower net revenues.Pre-taxearnings of $261 million in the first quarter of 2010 increased 6% compared with the first quarter of 2009.
 
Geographic Data
 
See Note 16 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor a summary of our total net revenues andpre-taxearnings by geographic region.
 
Off-Balance-SheetArrangements
 
We have various types ofoff-balance-sheetarrangements that we enter into in the ordinary course of business. Our involvement in these arrangements can take many different forms, including purchasing or retaining residual and other interests in special purpose entities such asmortgage-backedand otherasset-backedsecuritization vehicles; holding senior and subordinated debt, interests in limited and general partnerships, and preferred and common stock in other nonconsolidated vehicles; entering into interest rate, foreign currency, equity, commodity and credit derivatives, including total return swaps; entering into operating leases; and providing guarantees, indemnifications, loan commitments, letters of credit and representations and warranties.
 
We enter into these arrangements for a variety of business purposes, including the securitization of commercial and residential mortgages, corporate bonds, and other types of financial assets.Asset-backedfinancing vehicles are critical to the functioning of several significant investor markets, including themortgage-backedand otherasset-backedsecurities markets, since they offer investors access to specific cash flows and risks created through the securitization process. Other reasons for entering into these arrangements include underwriting client securitization transactions; providing secondary market liquidity; making investments in performing and nonperforming debt, equity, real estate and other assets; providing investors withcredit-linkedandasset-repackagednotes; and receiving or providing letters of credit to satisfy margin requirements and to facilitate the clearance and settlement process.
 
Our financial interests in, and derivative transactions with, such nonconsolidated entities are accounted for at fair value, in the same manner as our other financial instruments, except in cases where we apply the equity method of accounting.
 
When we transfer a security that has very little, if any, default risk under an agreement to repurchase the security where the maturity date of the repurchase agreement matches the maturity date of the underlying security (such that we effectively no longer have a repurchase obligation) and we have relinquished control over the underlying security, we record such transactions as sales. The amount of these transactions outstanding as of March 2010 was $48 million.

108


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth where a discussion ofoff-balance-sheetarrangements may be found in Part I, Items 1 and 2 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Q:
 
   
Type of Off-Balance-Sheet Arrangement Disclosure in Quarterly Report onForm 10-Q
 
 
   
Variable interests and other obligations, including contingent obligations, arising from variable interests in nonconsolidated VIEs See Note 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Q.
   
Leases, letters of credit, and loans and other commitments See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Q.
   
Guarantees See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Q.
   
Derivative contracts See Notes 3 and 7 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Q,“— CriticalAccounting Policies” above and“— Derivatives”below.
   
   
 
 
 
In addition, see Note 2 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor a discussion of our consolidation policies and recent accounting developments that affected these policies effective January 1, 2010.
 
Equity Capital
 
The level and composition of our equity capital are determined by multiple factors including our consolidated regulatory capital requirements and an internal capital adequacy assessment process (ICAAP), and may also be influenced by rating agency guidelines, subsidiary capital requirements, the business environment, conditions in the financial markets and assessments of potential future losses due to adverse changes in our business and market environments.
 
Our consolidated regulatory capital requirements are determined by the Federal Reserve Board, as described below. Our ICAAP incorporates an internalrisk-basedcapital (IRBC) assessment designed to identify and measure material risks associated with our business activities, including market risk, credit risk and operational risk, in a manner that is closely aligned with our risk management practices.
 
As of March 2010, our total shareholders’ equity was $72.94 billion (consisting of common shareholders’ equity of $65.99 billion and preferred stock of $6.96 billion). As of December 2009, our total shareholders’ equity was $70.71 billion (consisting of common shareholders’ equity of $63.76 billion and preferred stock of $6.96 billion). In addition to total shareholders’ equity, we consider our $5.00 billion of junior subordinated debt issued to trusts to be part of our equity capital, as it qualifies as capital for regulatory and certain rating agency purposes.
 
Consolidated Capital Requirements
 
The Federal Reserve Board is the primary U.S. regulator of Group Inc., a bank holding company and a financial holding company under the U.S. Bank Holding Company Act of 1956. As a bank holding company, we are subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements administered by the Federal Reserve Board. Under the Federal Reserve Board’s capital adequacy rules, Goldman Sachs must meet specific capital requirements that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities and

109


Table of Contents

certainoff-balance-sheetitems as calculated under regulatory reporting practices. The firm’s capital levels are also subject to qualitative judgments by its regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.
 
Consolidated Capital Ratios
 
The following table sets forth information regarding our consolidated capital ratios as of March 2010 calculated in accordance with the Federal Reserve Board’s regulatory capital requirements currently applicable to bank holding companies, which are based on Basel I. These ratios are used by the Federal Reserve Board and other U.S. federal banking agencies in the supervisory review process, including the assessment of our capital adequacy.
 
     
  As of
  March 2010
  ($ in millions)
Tier 1 Capital
    
Common shareholders’ equity
 $65,987 
Preferred stock
  6,957 
Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts
  5,000 
Less: Goodwill
  (3,575)
Less: Disallowable intangible assets
  (2,408)
Less: Other deductions (1)
  (3,489)
     
Tier 1 Capital
  68,472 
Tier 2 Capital
    
Qualifying subordinated debt (2)
  13,826 
Less: Other deductions (1)
  (285)
     
Tier 2 Capital
 $13,541 
     
Total Capital
 $82,013 
     
Risk-WeightedAssets
 $455,790 
     
Tier 1 Capital Ratio
  15.0%
Total Capital Ratio
  18.0%
Tier 1 Leverage Ratio
  8.1%
 
 
  (1) Principally includes equity investments innon-financialcompanies and the cumulative change in the fair value of our unsecured borrowings attributable to the impact of changes in our own credit spreads, disallowed deferred tax assets, and investments in certain nonconsolidated entities.
 
  (2) Substantially all of our subordinated debt qualifies as Tier 2 capital for Basel I purposes.
 
 
RWAs under the Federal Reserve Board’srisk-basedcapital guidelines are calculated based on the amount of market risk and credit risk. RWAs for market risk are determined by reference to our VaR models, supplemented by other measures to capture risks not reflected in our VaR models. Credit risk for on-balance sheet assets is based on the balance sheet value. For off-balance sheet exposures, including OTC derivatives and commitments, a credit equivalent amount is calculated based on the notional of each trade. All such assets and amounts are then assigned a risk weight depending on, among other things, whether the counterparty is a sovereign, bank or qualifying securities firm, or other entity (or if collateral is held, depending on the nature of the collateral).
 
Our Tier 1 leverage ratio is defined as Tier 1 capital under Basel I divided by adjusted average total assets (which includes adjustments for disallowed goodwill and certain intangible assets).

110


Table of Contents

Federal Reserve Board regulations require bank holding companies to maintain a minimum Tier 1 capital ratio of 4% and a minimum total capital ratio of 8%. The required minimum Tier 1 capital ratio and total capital ratio in order to be considered a “well capitalized” bank holding company under the Federal Reserve Board guidelines are 6% and 10%, respectively. Bank holding companies may be expected to maintain ratios well above the minimum levels, depending upon their particular condition, risk profile and growth plans. The minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio is 3% for bank holding companies that have received the highest supervisory rating under Federal Reserve Board guidelines or that have implemented the Federal Reserve Board’srisk-basedcapital measure for market risk. Other bank holding companies must have a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio of 4%.
 
During 2009, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision proposed several changes to the method of computing capital ratios. In addition, there are several other proposals which could potentially impact capital requirements. As a consequence, it is possible that minimum capital ratios required to be maintained under Federal Reserve Board regulations could be increased. It is also possible that changes in the prescribed calculation methodology could result in higher RWAs and lower capital ratios than those currently computed.
 
Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process
 
We perform an ICAAP with the objective of ensuring that the firm is appropriately capitalized relative to the risks in our business.
 
As part of our ICAAP, we perform an IRBC assessment. We evaluate capital adequacy based on the result of our IRBC assessment, supplemented with the results of stress tests which measure the firm’s performance under various market conditions. Our assessment of capital adequacy is viewed in tandem with our assessment of liquidity adequacy and integrated into the overall risk management structure, governance and policy framework of the firm.
 
We attribute capital usage to each of our business units based upon our IRBC framework and manage the levels of usage based upon the balance sheet and risk limits established.
 
Subsidiary Capital Requirements
 
Many of our subsidiaries are subject to separate regulation and capital requirements in jurisdictions throughout the world. GS Bank USA, a New York State-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC), is regulated by the Federal Reserve Board and the New York State Banking Department and is subject to minimum capital requirements that (subject to certain exceptions) are similar to those applicable to bank holding companies. GS Bank USA and its subsidiaries are subject to the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action (PCA). GS Bank USA computes its capital ratios in accordance with the regulatory capital guidelines currently applicable to state member banks, which are based on Basel I as implemented by the Federal Reserve Board. In addition, for purposes of assessing the adequacy of its capital, GS Bank USA has established an ICAAP which is similar to that used by Group Inc. GS Bank USA’s capital levels and PCA classification are subject to qualitative judgments by its regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.
 
Goldman, Sachs & Co. (GS&Co.) and Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P. (GSEC) are registeredU.S. broker-dealersand futures commission merchants, and are subject to regulatory capital requirements, including those imposed by the SEC, the Commodity Futures Trading Commission, CME Group Inc., the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. and the National Futures Association. Goldman Sachs International (GSI) and Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd., our principalnon-U.S. regulatedbroker-dealersubsidiaries, are subject to the capital requirements of the U.K.’s Financial Services Authority and Japan’s Financial Services Agency, respectively.

111


Table of Contents

See Note 15 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor information regarding GS Bank USA’s capital ratios under Basel I as implemented by the Federal Reserve Board, and for further information regarding the capital requirements of our other regulated subsidiaries.
 
Subsidiaries not subject to separate regulatory capital requirements may hold capital to satisfy local tax guidelines, rating agency requirements (for entities with assigned credit ratings) or internal policies, including policies concerning the minimum amount of capital a subsidiary should hold based on its underlying level of risk. In certain instances, Group Inc. may be limited in its ability to access capital held at certain subsidiaries as a result of regulatory, tax or other constraints. As of March 2010 and December 2009, Group Inc.’s equity investment in subsidiaries was $69.15 billion and $65.74 billion, respectively, compared with its total shareholders’ equity of $72.94 billion and $70.71 billion, respectively.
 
Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of GS&Co., GS Bank USA, GS Bank Europe and GSEC subject to certain exceptions. In November 2008, we contributed subsidiaries into GS Bank USA, and Group Inc. agreed to guarantee certain losses, includingcredit-relatedlosses, relating to assets held by the contributed entities. In connection with this guarantee, Group Inc. also agreed to pledge to GS Bank USA certain collateral, including interests in subsidiaries and other illiquid assets.
 
Our capital invested innon-U.S. subsidiariesis generally exposed to foreign exchange risk, substantially all of which is managed through a combination of derivative contracts andnon-U.S. denominateddebt.
 
Rating Agency Guidelines
 
The credit rating agencies assign credit ratings to the obligations of Group Inc., which directly issues or guarantees substantially all of the firm’s senior unsecured obligations. GS Bank USA has also been assignedlong-termissuer ratings as well as ratings on itslong-termandshort-termbank deposits. In addition, credit rating agencies have assigned ratings to debt obligations of certain other subsidiaries of Group Inc.
 
The level and composition of our equity capital are among the many factors considered in determining our credit ratings. Each agency has its own definition of eligible capital and methodology for evaluating capital adequacy, and assessments are generally based on a combination of factors rather than a single calculation. See“— Liquidityand Funding Risk — Credit Ratings” below for further information regarding our credit ratings.
 
Equity Capital Management
 
Our objective is to maintain a sufficient level and optimal composition of equity capital. We principally manage our capital through issuances and repurchases of our common stock. We may also, from time to time, issue or repurchase our preferred stock, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts and other subordinated debt as business conditions warrant and subject to any regulatory approvals. We manage our capital requirements principally by setting limits on balance sheet assetsand/orlimits on risk, in each case at both the consolidated and business unit levels. We attribute capital usage to each of our business units based upon our IRBC framework and manage the levels of usage based upon the balance sheet and risk limits established.

112


Table of Contents

Preferred Stock.  In October 2008, we issued to Berkshire Hathaway and certain affiliates 50,000 shares of 10% Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series G (Series G Preferred Stock), and a five-year warrant to purchase up to 43.5 million shares of common stock at an exercise price of $115.00 per share, for aggregate proceeds of $5.00 billion. The allocated carrying values of the warrant and the Series G Preferred Stock (based on their relative fair values on the date of issuance) were $1.14 billion and $3.86 billion, respectively. The Series G Preferred Stock is redeemable at the firm’s option, subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Board, at a redemption value of $5.50 billion, plus accrued and unpaid dividends. Accordingly, upon a redemption in full at any time in the future of the Series G Preferred Stock, we would recognize aone-timepreferred dividend of $1.64 billion (calculated as the difference between the carrying value and redemption value of the preferred stock), which would be recorded as a reduction to our earnings applicable to common shareholders and to our common shareholders’ equity in the period of redemption.
 
Share Repurchase Program.  We seek to use our share repurchase program to substantially offset increases in share count over time resulting from employeeshare-basedcompensation and to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity. The repurchase program is effected primarily through regularopen-marketpurchases, the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by our issuance of shares resulting from employeeshare-basedcompensation as well as our current and projected capital position (i.e., comparisons of our desired level of capital to our actual level of capital), but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of our common stock. Any repurchase of our common stock requires approval by the Federal Reserve Board.
 
As of March 2010, under the Board’s existing share repurchase program, we can repurchase up to 47.7 million additional shares of common stock; however, any such repurchases are subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Board. See “Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds” in Part II, Item 2 and Note 9 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor additional information on our repurchase program.
 
See Notes 7 and 9 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding our preferred stock, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts and other subordinated debt.

113


Table of Contents

Capital Ratios and Metrics
 
The following table sets forth information on our assets, shareholders’ equity, leverage ratios, capital ratios and book value per common share:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  ($ in millions, except per share amounts)
Total assets
 $880,528  $848,942 
Adjusted assets (1)
  548,503   546,151 
Total shareholders’ equity
  72,944   70,714 
Tangible equity capital (2)
  71,961   70,794 
Leverage ratio (3)
  12.1x  12.0x
Adjusted leverage ratio (4)
  7.6x  7.7x
Debt to equity ratio (5)
  2.5x  2.6x
Common shareholders’ equity
 $65,987  $63,757 
Tangible common shareholders’ equity (6)
  60,004   58,837 
Book value per common share (7)
  122.52   117.48 
Tangible book value per common share (6)(7)
  111.41   108.42 
         
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  Basel I (8)
Tier 1 capital ratio
  15.0%  15.0%
Total capital ratio
  18.0%  18.2%
Tier 1 leverage ratio
  8.1%  7.6%
Tier 1 common ratio (9)
  12.4%  12.2%
Tangible common shareholders’ equity (6)torisk-weightedassets ratio
  13.2%  13.6%
 
 
  (1) Adjusted assets excludes(i) low-riskcollateralized assets generally associated with our matched book and securities lending businesses and federal funds sold, (ii) cash and securities we segregate for regulatory and other purposes and (iii) goodwill and identifiable intangible assets which are deducted when calculating tangible equity capital (see footnote 2 below).
 
The following table sets forth the reconciliation of total assets to adjusted assets:
 
           
    As of
    March
 December
    2010 2009
    (in millions)
Total assets
 $880,528  $848,942 
Deduct:
 Securities borrowed  (202,841)  (189,939)
  Securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold  (166,368)  (144,279)
Add:
 Trading liabilities, at fair value  140,081   129,019 
  Less derivative liabilities  (53,861)  (56,009)
           
  Subtotal  86,220   73,010 
Deduct:
 Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes  (43,053)  (36,663)
  Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets  (5,983)  (4,920)
           
Adjusted assets
 $548,503  $546,151 
         
 
  (2) Tangible equity capital equals total shareholders’ equity and junior subordinated debt issued to trusts less goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. We consider junior subordinated debt issued to trusts to be a component of our tangible equity capital base due to certain characteristics of the debt, including itslong-termnature, our ability to defer payments due on the debt and the subordinated nature of the debt in our capital structure.

114


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity to tangible equity capital:
 
           
    As of
    March
 December
    2010 2009
    (in millions)
Total shareholders’ equity
 $72,944  $70,714 
Add:
 Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts  5,000   5,000 
Deduct:
 Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets  (5,983)  (4,920)
           
Tangible equity capital
 $71,961  $70,794 
         
 
  (3) The leverage ratio equals total assets divided by total shareholders’ equity. This ratio is different from the Tier 1 leverage ratio included above, which is described in Note 15 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Q.
 
  (4) The adjusted leverage ratio equals adjusted assets divided by tangible equity capital. We believe that the adjusted leverage ratio is a more meaningful measure of our capital adequacy than the leverage ratio because it excludes certainlow-riskcollateralized assets that are generally supported with little or no capital and reflects the tangible equity capital deployed in our businesses.
 
  (5) The debt to equity ratio equals unsecuredlong-termborrowings divided by total shareholders’ equity.
 
  (6) Tangible common shareholders’ equity equals total shareholders’ equity less preferred stock, goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. Tangible book value per common share is computed by dividing tangible common shareholders’ equity by the number of common shares outstanding, including RSUs granted to employees with no future service requirements. We believe that tangible common shareholders’ equity and tangible book value per common share are meaningful because they are measures that we and investors use to assess capital adequacy.
 
The following table sets forth the reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity to tangible common shareholders’ equity:
 
           
    As of
    March
 December
    2010 2009
    (in millions)
Total shareholders’ equity
 $72,944  $70,714 
Deduct:
 Preferred stock  (6,957)  (6,957)
           
Common shareholders’ equity
  65,987   63,757 
Deduct:
 Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets  (5,983)  (4,920)
           
Tangible common shareholders’ equity
 $60,004  $58,837 
         
 
  (7) Book value and tangible book value per common share are based on common shares outstanding, including RSUs granted to employees with no future service requirements, of 538.6 million and 542.7 million as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
  (8) Calculated in accordance with the regulatory capital requirements currently applicable to bank holding companies. RWAs were $455.79 billion and $431.89 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, under Basel I. See Note 15 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding our regulatory capital ratios.
 
  (9) The Tier 1 common ratio equals Tier 1 capital less preferred stock and junior subordinated debt issued to trusts, divided by RWAs. We believe that the Tier 1 common ratio is meaningful because it is one of the measures that we and investors use to assess capital adequacy.
 
The following table sets forth the reconciliation of Tier 1 capital to Tier 1 common capital:
 
           
    As of
    March
 December
    2010 2009
    (in millions)
Tier 1 capital
 $68,472  $64,642 
Deduct:
 Preferred stock  (6,957)  (6,957)
  Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts  (5,000)  (5,000)
           
Tier 1 common capital
 $56,515  $52,685 
         

115


Table of Contents

 
Contractual Obligations
 
Goldman Sachs has contractual obligations to make future payments related to our unsecuredlong-termborrowings, securedlong-termfinancings, time deposits,long-termnoncancelable lease agreements and purchase obligations and has commitments under a variety of commercial arrangements.
 
The following table sets forth our contractual obligations by maturity date as of March 2010:
 
Contractual Obligations
(in millions)
 
                     
  Remainder
 2011-
 2013-
 2015-
  
  of 2010 2012 2014 Thereafter Total
Unsecuredlong-termborrowings (1)(2)(3)
 $  $43,566  $40,736  $96,112  $180,414 
Securedlong-termfinancings (1)(2)(4)
     7,127   3,387   2,681   13,195 
Time deposits (5)
     1,991   2,314   2,121   6,426 
Contractual interest payments (6)
  5,006   12,804   9,801   29,645   57,256 
Insurance liabilities (7)
  517   1,610   1,041   8,636   11,804 
Minimum rental payments
  376   765   508   1,559   3,208 
Purchase obligations
  179   54   41   31   305 
 
 
  (1) Obligations maturing within one year of our financial statement date or redeemable within one year of our financial statement date at the option of the holder are excluded from this table and are treated asshort-termobligations. See Note 3 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding our secured financings.
 
  (2) Obligations that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of Goldman Sachs are reflected at their contractual maturity dates. Obligations that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the dates such options become exercisable.
 
  (3) Amount includes an increase of $6.44 billion to the carrying amount of certain of the firm’s unsecuredlong-termborrowings related to fair value hedges. In addition, the aggregate contractual principal amount of unsecuredlong-termborrowings (principal andnon-principalprotected) for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $557 million.
 
  (4) The aggregate contractual principal amount of securedlong-termfinancings for which the fair value option was elected, primarily consisting of transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales, debt raised through our William Street credit extension program and certain other nonrecourse financings, exceeded the related fair value by $398 million.
 
  (5) Excludes $3.04 billion of time deposits maturing within one year of our financial statement date.
 
  (6) Represents estimated future interest payments related to unsecuredlong-termborrowings, securedlong-termfinancings and time deposits based on applicable interest rates as of March 2010. Includes stated coupons, if any, on structured notes.
 
  (7) Represents estimated undiscounted payments related to future benefits and unpaid claims arising from policies associated with our insurance activities, excluding separate accounts and estimated recoveries under reinsurance contracts.
 
 
As of March 2010, our unsecuredlong-termborrowings were $180.41 billion, with maturities extending to 2043, and consisted principally of senior borrowings. See Note 7 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding our unsecuredlong-termborrowings.
 
As of March 2010, our future minimum rental payments, net of minimum sublease rentals, under noncancelable leases were $3.21 billion. These lease commitments, principally for office space, expire on various dates through 2069. Certain agreements are subject to periodic escalation provisions for increases in real estate taxes and other charges. See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding our leases.

116


Table of Contents

Our occupancy expenses include costs associated with office space held in excess of our current requirements. This excess space, the cost of which is charged to earnings as incurred, is being held for potential growth or to replace currently occupied space that we may exit in the future. We regularly evaluate our current and future space capacity in relation to current and projected staffing levels. During the first quarter of 2010, total occupancy expenses for space held in excess of our current requirements was approximately $20 million, which includes costs related to the transition to our new headquarters in New York City. We may incur exit costs in the future to the extent we (i) reduce our space capacity or (ii) commit to, or occupy, new properties in the locations in which we operate and, consequently, dispose of existing space that had been held for potential growth. These exit costs may be material to our results of operations in a given period.
 
As of March 2010, included in purchase obligations was $93 million ofconstruction-relatedobligations. As of March 2010, ourconstruction-relatedobligations include commitments of $52 million related to our new headquarters in New York City. Initial occupancy of our new headquarters occurred during the fourth quarter of 2009.
 
Due to the uncertainty of the timing and amounts that will ultimately be paid, our liability for unrecognized tax benefits has been excluded from the above contractual obligations table.
 
See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor information regarding our commitments, contingencies and guarantees.

117


Table of Contents

 
Market Risk
 
The potential for changes in the market value of our trading and investing positions is referred to as market risk. Such positions result frommarket-making,underwriting, investing activities and proprietary trading. Substantially all of our inventory positions aremarked-to-marketon a daily basis and changes are recorded in net revenues.
 
Categories of market risk include exposures to interest rates, equity prices, currency rates and commodity prices. A description of each market risk category is set forth below:
 
  • Interest rate risks primarily result from exposures to changes in the level, slope and curvature of the yield curve, the volatility of interest rates, mortgage prepayment speeds and credit spreads.
 
  • Equity price risks result from exposures to changes in prices and volatilities of individual equities, equity baskets and equity indices.
 
  • Currency rate risks result from exposures to changes in spot prices, forward prices and volatilities of currency rates.
 
  • Commodity price risks result from exposures to changes in spot prices, forward prices and volatilities of commodities, such as electricity, natural gas, crude oil, petroleum products, and precious and base metals.
 
We seek to manage these risks by diversifying exposures, controlling position sizes and establishing economic hedges in related securities or derivatives. For example, we may seek to hedge a portfolio of common stocks by taking an offsetting position in a relatedequity-indexfutures contract. The ability to manage an exposure may, however, be limited by adverse changes in the liquidity of the security or the related hedge instrument and in the correlation of price movements between the security and related hedge instrument.
 
In addition to applying business judgment, senior management uses a number of quantitative tools to manage our exposure to market risk for “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. These tools include:
 
  • risk limits based on a summary measure of market risk exposure referred to as VaR;
 
  • scenario analyses, stress tests and other analytical tools that measure the potential effects on our trading net revenues of various market events, including, but not limited to, a large widening of credit spreads, a substantial decline in equity markets and significant moves in selected emerging markets; and
 
  • inventory position limits for selected business units.
 
VaR
 
VaR is the potential loss in value of trading positions due to adverse market movements over a defined time horizon with a specified confidence level.
 
For the VaR numbers reported below, aone-day time horizon and a 95% confidence level were used. This means that there is a 1 in 20 chance that daily trading net revenues will fall below the expected daily trading net revenues by an amount at least as large as the reported VaR. Thus, shortfalls from expected trading net revenues on a single trading day greater than the reported VaR would be anticipated to occur, on average, about once a month. Shortfalls on a single day can exceed reported VaR by significant amounts. Shortfalls can also occur more frequently or accumulate over a longer time horizon such as a number of consecutive trading days.

118


Table of Contents

The modeling of the risk characteristics of our trading positions involves a number of assumptions and approximations. While we believe that these assumptions and approximations are reasonable, there is no standard methodology for estimating VaR, and different assumptionsand/orapproximations could produce materially different VaR estimates.
 
We use historical data to estimate our VaR and, to better reflect current asset volatilities, we generally weight historical data to give greater importance to more recent observations. Given its reliance on historical data, VaR is most effective in estimating risk exposures in markets in which there are no sudden fundamental changes or shifts in market conditions. An inherent limitation of VaR is that the distribution of past changes in market risk factors may not produce accurate predictions of future market risk. Different VaR methodologies and distributional assumptions could produce a materially different VaR. Moreover, VaR calculated for aone-day time horizon does not fully capture the market risk of positions that cannot be liquidated or offset with hedges within one day.
 
The following tables set forth the daily VaR:
 
Average Daily VaR(1)
(in millions)
 
         
  Average for the
  Three Months Ended
  March
 March
Risk Categories
 2010 2009
Interest rates
 $109  $218 
Equity prices
  88   38 
Currency rates
  35   38 
Commodity prices
  49   40 
Diversification effect (2)
  (120)  (94)
         
Total
 $161  $240 
         
 
 
  (1) Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR, where VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk (e.g., due to transfer restrictionsand/orilliquidity). See“— OtherMarket Risk Measures” below.
 
  (2) Equals the difference between total VaR and the sum of the VaRs for the four risk categories. This effect arises because the four market risk categories are not perfectly correlated.
 
 
Our average daily VaR decreased to $161 million for the first quarter of 2010 from $240 million for the first quarter of 2009, principally due to a decrease in the interest rates category and an increase in the diversification benefit across risk categories, partially offset by an increase in the equity prices category. The decrease in interest rates was primarily due to reduced rate exposures and lower levels of volatility. The increase in equity prices was primarily due to increased equity exposures.
 
VaR excludes the impact of changes in counterparty and our own credit spreads on derivatives as well as changes in our own credit spreads on unsecured borrowings for which the fair value option was elected. The estimated sensitivity of our net revenues to a one basis point increase in credit spreads (counterparty and our own) on derivatives was a $2 million gain as of March 2010. In addition, the estimated sensitivity of our net revenues to a one basis point increase in our own credit spreads on unsecured borrowings for which the fair value option was elected was a $9 million gain (including hedges) as of March 2010.

119


Table of Contents

Daily VaR(1)
(in millions)
 
                 
  As of Three Months Ended
  March
 December
 March 2010
Risk Categories
 2010 2009 High Low
Interest rates
 $90  $122  $123  $90 
Equity prices
  93   99   124   58 
Currency rates
  57   21   57   20 
Commodity prices
  35   33   62   33 
Diversification effect (2)
  (111)  (122)        
                 
Total
 $164  $153  $196  $142 
                 
 
 
  (1) Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR, where VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk (e.g., due to transfer restrictionsand/orilliquidity). See“— OtherMarket Risk Measures” below.
 
  (2) Equals the difference between total VaR and the sum of the VaRs for the four risk categories. This effect arises because the four market risk categories are not perfectly correlated.
 
 
Our daily VaR increased to $164 million as of March 2010 from $153 million as of December 2009, primarily due to an increase in the currency rates category and a decrease in the diversification benefit across risk categories, partially offset by a decrease in the interest rates category. The increase in currency rates was principally due to higher levels of exposure. The decrease in interest rates was primarily due to reduced rate exposures and lower levels of volatility.
 
The following chart presents our daily VaR during the last four quarters:
 
Daily VaR
($ in millions)
 
(LINE GRAPH)

120


Table of Contents

Trading Net Revenues Distribution
 
The following chart sets forth the frequency distribution of our daily trading net revenues for substantially all inventory positions included in VaR for the quarter ended March 2010:
 
Daily Trading Net Revenues
($ in millions)
 
 
 
As part of our overall risk control process, daily trading net revenues are compared with VaR calculated as of the end of the prior business day. Trading losses incurred on a single day did not exceed our 95%one-day VaR during the first quarter of 2010.
 
Other Market Risk Measures
 
Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR, where VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk (e.g., due to transfer restrictionsand/orilliquidity). The market risk related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, excluding interests held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs, is measured by estimating the potential reduction in net revenues associated with a 10% decline in the ICBC ordinary share price. The market risk related to the remaining positions is measured by estimating the potential reduction in net revenues associated with a 10% decline in asset values.
 
The sensitivity analyses for these equity and debt positions in the FICC and Equities components of our Trading and Principal Investments segment and equity, debt (primarily mezzanine instruments) and real estate positions in the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment are measured by the impact of a decline in the asset values (including the impact of leverage in the underlying investments for real estate positions in the Principal Investments component) of such positions. The fair value of the underlying positions may be impacted by recentthird-partyinvestments or pending transactions,third-partyindependent appraisals, transactions in similar instruments, valuation multiples and public comparables, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.

121


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth market risk for positions not included in VaR. These measures do not reflect diversification benefits across asset categories and, given the differing likelihood of the potential declines in asset categories, these measures have not been aggregated:
 
           
Asset Categories
 
10% Sensitivity Measure
 10% Sensitivity
    Amount as of
    March 2010 December 2009
    (in millions)
FICC and Equities(1)
          
Equity (2)
 Underlying asset value $548  $616 
Debt (3)
 Underlying asset value  375   431 
         
Principal Investments (4)
        
ICBC
 ICBC ordinary share price  277   298 
Other Equity (5)
 Underlying asset value  954   1,001 
Debt (6)
 Underlying asset value  972   947 
Real Estate (7)
 Underlying asset value  675   690 
 
 
  (1) In addition to the positions in these portfolios, which are accounted for at fair value, we make investments accounted for under the equity method and we also make direct investments in real estate, both of which are included in “Other assets” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. Direct investments in real estate are accounted for at cost less accumulated depreciation. See Note 12 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor information on “Other assets.”
 
  (2) Relates to private and restricted public equity securities held within the FICC and Equities components of our Trading and Principal Investments segment.
 
  (3) Primarily relates to acquired portfolios of distressed loans (primarily backed by commercial and residential real estate collateral), loans backed by commercial real estate, and corporate debt held within the FICC component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment.
 
  (4) Represents investments included within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment.
 
  (5) Primarily relates to interests in our merchant banking funds that invest in corporate equities.
 
  (6) Primarily relates to interests in our merchant banking funds that invest in corporate mezzanine debt instruments.
 
  (7) Primarily relates to interests in our merchant banking funds that invest in real estate. Such funds typically employ leverage as part of the investment strategy. This sensitivity measure is based on our percentage ownership of the underlying asset values in the funds and unfunded commitments to the funds.
 
 
In addition to the positions included in VaR and the other risk measures described above, as of March 2010, we held approximately $10.45 billion of financial instruments in our bank and insurance subsidiaries, primarily consisting of $4.61 billion of money market instruments, $1.38 billion of government and U.S. federal agency obligations, $2.78 billion of corporate debt securities and other debt obligations, and $1.31 billion of mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities. As of December 2009, we held approximately $10.70 billion of financial instruments in our bank and insurance subsidiaries, primarily consisting of $5.12 billion of money market instruments, $1.25 billion of government and U.S. federal agency obligations, $2.78 billion of corporate debt securities and other debt obligations, and $1.31 billion of mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities. In addition, as of March 2010 and December 2009, we held commitments and loans under the William Street credit extension program. See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding our William Street credit extension program.

122


Table of Contents

 
Credit Risk
 
Credit risk represents the loss that we would incur if a counterparty or an issuer of securities or other instruments we hold fails to perform under its contractual obligations to us, or upon a deterioration in the credit quality of third parties whose securities or other instruments, including OTC derivatives, we hold. Our exposure to credit risk principally arises through our trading, investing and financing activities. To reduce our credit exposures, we seek to enter into netting agreements with counterparties that permit us to offset receivables and payables with such counterparties. In addition, we attempt to further reduce credit risk with certain counterparties by (i) entering into agreements that enable us to obtain collateral from a counterparty on an upfront or contingent basis, (ii) seekingthird-partyguarantees of the counterparty’s obligations,and/or(iii) transferring our credit risk to third parties using credit derivativesand/or other structures and techniques.
 
To measure and manage our credit exposures, we use a variety of tools, including credit limits referenced to potential exposure. Potential exposure is an estimate of exposure, within a specified confidence level, that could be outstanding over the life of a transaction based on market movements. In addition, as part of our market risk management process, for positions measured by changes in credit spreads, we use VaR and other sensitivity measures. To supplement our primary credit exposure measures, we also use scenario analyses, such as credit spread widening scenarios, stress tests and other quantitative tools.
 
Our global credit management systems monitor credit exposure to individual counterparties and on an aggregate basis to counterparties and their subsidiaries. These systems also provide management, including the Firmwide Risk and Credit Policy Committees, with information regarding credit risk by product, industry sector, country and region.
 
While our activities expose us to many different industries and counterparties, we routinely execute a high volume of transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, clearing houses, exchanges and investment funds. This has resulted in significant credit concentration with respect to this industry. In the ordinary course of business, we may also be subject to a concentration of credit risk to a particular counterparty, borrower or issuer, including sovereign issuers, or to a particular clearing house or exchange.
 
As of March 2010 and December 2009, we held $88.58 billion (10% of total assets) and $83.83 billion (10% of total assets), respectively, of U.S. government and federal agency obligations included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. We held $42.75 billion (5% of total assets) and $38.61 billion (5% of total assets) of other sovereign obligations as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, principally consisting of securities issued by the governments of the United Kingdom, Japan and Germany as of March 2010, and the United Kingdom and Japan as of December 2009. In addition, as of March 2010 and December 2009, $108.42 billion and $87.63 billion of our securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed (including those in “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes” in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition), respectively, were collateralized by U.S. government and federal agency obligations. Our securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed collateralized by other sovereign obligations were $83.93 billion and $77.99 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, principally consisting of securities issued by the governments of Germany, France, Japan and the United Kingdom as of March 2010, and Germany, the United Kingdom and Japan as of December 2009. As of March 2010 and December 2009, we did not have credit exposure to any other counterparty that exceeded 2% of our total assets.

123


Table of Contents

 
Derivatives
 
Derivative contracts are instruments such as futures, forwards, swaps or option contracts that derive their value from underlying asset prices, indices, reference rates and other inputs or a combination of these factors. Derivative instruments may be privately negotiated contracts, which are often referred to as OTC derivatives, or they may be listed and traded on an exchange.
 
Substantially all of our derivative transactions are entered into to facilitate client transactions, as a means of risk management or to take proprietary positions. In addition to derivative transactions entered into for trading purposes, we enter into derivative contracts to manage currency exposure on our net investment innon-U.S. operationsand to manage the interest rate and currency exposure on ourlong-termborrowings and certainshort-termborrowings.
 
Derivatives are used in many of our businesses, and we believe that the associated market risk can only be understood relative to all of the underlying assets or risks being hedged, or as part of a broader trading strategy. Accordingly, the market risk of derivative positions is managed together with our nonderivative positions.
 
The fair value of our derivative contracts is reflected net of cash paid or received pursuant to credit support agreements and is reported on anet-by-counterpartybasis in our consolidated statements of financial condition when we believe a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement. For an OTC derivative, our credit exposure is directly with our counterparty and continues until the maturity or termination of such contract.

124


Table of Contents

The following tables set forth the fair values of our OTC derivative assets and liabilities by tenor and by product type or credit rating. Tenor is based on expected duration formortgage-relatedcredit derivatives and generally on remaining contractual maturity for other derivatives. For option contracts that require settlement by delivery of an underlying derivative instrument, the tenor is generally classified based upon the maturity date of the underlying derivative instrument. In those instances where the underlying instrument does not have a maturity date or either counterparty has the right to settle in cash, the tenor is generally based upon the option expiration date.
 
The following tables set forth the fair values of our OTC derivative assets and liabilities by product type and by tenor:
 
OTC Derivatives
(in millions)
 
                     
Assets As of March 2010
  0 - 12
 1 - 5
 5 - 10
 10 Years
  
Product Type
 Months Years Years or Greater Total
Interest rates
 $11,457  $36,858  $24,756  $39,127  $112,198 
Credit
  3,456   21,147   10,249   5,844   40,696 
Currencies
  9,469   10,954   5,203   6,852   32,478 
Commodities
  5,596   6,248   436   8   12,288 
Equities
  6,124   8,815   4,953   2,086   21,978 
Netting across product types (1)
  (2,754)  (5,565)  (2,946)  (1,512)  (12,777)
                     
Subtotal
 $33,348 (4) $78,457  $42,651  $52,405  $206,861 
                     
Cross maturity netting (2)
                  (24,350)
Cash collateral netting (3)
                  (118,754)
                     
Total
                 $63,757 
                     
                     
                     
Liabilities          
  0 - 12
 1 - 5
 5 - 10
 10 Years
  
Product Type
 Months Years Years or Greater Total
Interest rates
 $5,322  $13,386  $11,876  $13,979  $44,563 
Credit
  1,439   5,970   2,340   2,270   12,019 
Currencies
  10,103   4,523   2,664   2,217   19,507 
Commodities
  6,006   7,314   1,056   722   15,098 
Equities
  4,471   4,023   3,344   510   12,348 
Netting across product types (1)
  (2,754)  (5,565)  (2,946)  (1,512)  (12,777)
                     
Subtotal
 $24,587 (4) $29,651  $18,334  $18,186  $90,758 
                     
Cross maturity netting (2)
                  (24,350)
Cash collateral netting (3)
                  (14,501)
                     
Total
                 $51,907 
                     
 
 
  (1) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across product types within a tenor category, pursuant to enforceable netting agreements. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same product type and tenor category are netted within such product type and tenor category, where appropriate.
 
  (2) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across tenor categories, pursuant to enforceable netting agreements.
 
  (3) Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
  (4) Includes fair values of OTC derivative assets and liabilities, maturing within six months, of $19.94 billion and $15.91 billion, respectively.

125


Table of Contents

OTC Derivatives
(in millions)
 
                     
Assets As of December 2009
  0 - 12
 1 - 5
 5 - 10
 10 Years
  
Product Type
 Months Years Years or Greater Total
Interest rates
 $14,266  $37,146  $25,608  $37,721  $114,741 
Credit
  5,743   20,465   11,497   6,281   43,986 
Currencies
  9,870   12,789   6,408   6,955   36,022 
Commodities
  6,201   7,546   521   41   14,309 
Equities
  6,742   8,818   4,920   2,350   22,830 
Netting across product types (1)
  (3,480)  (6,256)  (3,047)  (1,399)  (14,182)
                     
Subtotal
 $39,342 (4) $80,508  $45,907  $51,949  $217,706 
                     
Cross maturity netting (2)
                  (24,681)
Cash collateral netting (3)
                  (124,603)
                     
Total
                 $68,422 
                     
                     
                     
Liabilities          
  0 - 12
 1 - 5
 5 - 10
 10 Years
  
Product Type
 Months Years Years or Greater Total
Interest rates
 $7,042  $12,831  $11,421  $12,518  $43,812 
Credit
  2,487   7,168   2,356   2,116   14,127 
Currencies
  12,202   4,003   2,789   2,132   21,126 
Commodities
  6,922   7,161   1,157   846   16,086 
Equities
  4,213   3,746   3,371   586   11,916 
Netting across product types (1)
  (3,480)  (6,256)  (3,047)  (1,399)  (14,182)
                     
Subtotal
 $29,386 (4) $28,653  $18,047  $16,799  $92,885 
                     
Cross maturity netting (2)
                  (24,681)
Cash collateral netting (3)
                  (14,743)
                     
Total
                 $53,461 
                     
 
 
  (1) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across product types within a tenor category, pursuant to enforceable netting agreements. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same product type and tenor category are netted within such product type and tenor category, where appropriate.
 
  (2) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across tenor categories, pursuant to enforceable netting agreements.
 
  (3) Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
  (4) Includes fair values of OTC derivative assets and liabilities, maturing within six months, of $21.60 billion and $18.08 billion, respectively.

126


Table of Contents

The following tables set forth the distribution, by credit rating, of our exposure with respect to OTC derivatives by tenor, both before and after consideration of the effect of collateral and netting agreements. The categories shown reflect our internally determined public rating agency equivalents:
 
OTC Derivative Credit Exposure
(in millions)
 
                                 
  As of March 2010
                Exposure
Credit Rating
 0 - 12
 1 - 5
 5 - 10
 10 Years
       Net of
Equivalent    
 Months Years Years or Greater Total Netting (2) Exposure Collateral
 
AAA/Aaa
 $890  $2,586  $2,047  $2,153  $7,676  $(2,781) $4,895  $4,475 
AA/Aa2
  4,736   11,186   8,331   9,601   33,854   (23,401)  10,453   7,144 
A/A2
  18,588   47,069   27,228   31,547   124,432   (100,712)  23,720   19,883 
BBB/Baa2
  4,634   8,202   2,860   7,853   23,549   (12,304)  11,245   5,824 
BB/Ba2 or lower
  3,793   8,206   1,899   1,065   14,963   (3,710)  11,253   7,168 
Unrated
  707   1,208   286   186   2,387   (196)  2,191   1,494 
                                 
Total
 $33,348 (1) $78,457  $42,651  $52,405  $206,861  $(143,104) $63,757  $45,988 
                                 
                                 
                                 
  As of December 2009
                Exposure
Credit Rating
 0 - 12
 1 - 5
 5 - 10
 10 Years
       Net of
Equivalent    
 Months Years Years or Greater Total Netting (2) Exposure Collateral
 
AAA/Aaa
 $2,020  $3,157  $3,507  $2,567  $11,251  $(5,603) $5,648  $5,109 
AA/Aa2
  5,285   10,745   7,090   8,954   32,074   (19,653)  12,421   8,735 
A/A2
  22,707   47,891   30,267   31,203   132,068   (107,942)  24,126   20,111 
BBB/Baa2
  4,402   8,300   3,024   7,830   23,556   (11,064)  12,492   6,202 
BB/Ba2 or lower
  4,444   9,438   1,735   1,354   16,971   (4,914)  12,057   7,381 
Unrated
  484   977   284   41   1,786   (108)  1,678   1,161 
                                 
Total
 $39,342 (1) $80,508  $45,907  $51,949  $217,706  $(149,284) $68,422  $48,699 
                                 
 
 
(1)  Includes fair values of OTC derivative assets, maturing within six months, of $19.94 billion and $21.60 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively.
 
(2)  Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across tenor categories, pursuant to enforceable netting agreements, and the netting of cash collateral received, pursuant to credit support agreements. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same tenor category are netted within such tenor category, where appropriate.
 
 
Derivative transactions may also involve legal risks including the risk that they are not authorized or appropriate for a counterparty, that documentation has not been properly executed or that executed agreements may not be enforceable against the counterparty. We attempt to minimize these risks by obtaining advice of counsel on the enforceability of agreements as well as on the authority of a counterparty to effect the derivative transaction. In addition, certain derivative transactions (e.g., credit derivative contracts) involve the risk that we may have difficulty obtaining, or be unable to obtain, the underlying security or obligation in order to satisfy any physical settlement requirement.

127


Table of Contents

 
Liquidity and Funding Risk
 
Liquidity is of critical importance to companies in the financial services sector. Most failures of financial institutions have occurred in large part due to insufficient liquidity. Accordingly, Goldman Sachs has in place a comprehensive set of liquidity and funding policies that are intended to maintain significant flexibility to address both Goldman Sachs-specific and broader industry or market liquidity events. Our principal objective is to be able to fund Goldman Sachs and to enable our core businesses to continue to generate revenues, even under adverse circumstances.
 
We manage liquidity risk according to the following framework:
 
  • Excess Liquidity.  We maintain substantial excess liquidity to meet a broad range of potential cash outflows in a stressed environment, including financing obligations. The amount of our excess liquidity is based on an internal liquidity model together with a qualitative assessment of the condition of the financial markets and of Goldman Sachs.
 
  • Asset-LiabilityManagement.  Our funding strategy includes an assessment of the overall characteristics of our assets with respect to their anticipated holding periods and potential illiquidity in a stressed environment. In addition, we manage the maturities and diversity of our secured and unsecured funding liabilities across markets, products and counterparties, and we seek to maintain liabilities of appropriate term relative to our asset base.
 
  • Contingency Funding Plan (CFP).  We maintain a CFP to help identify, measure, monitor and mitigate liquidity and funding risk. The CFP considers various risk factors that could occur during a crisis and provides a framework for analyzing and responding to a liquidity crisis.
 
During 2009, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision introduced for public comment a new framework for liquidity risk management for financial institutions. While the principles behind the proposed measures are broadly consistent with our liquidity management framework and policies, it is possible that the final standards could impact the firm’s liquidity and funding requirements and practices.
 
Excess Liquidity
 
Our most important liquidity policy is topre-fundwhat we estimate will be our potential cash needs during a liquidity crisis and hold such excess liquidity in the form of unencumbered, highly liquid securities that may be sold or pledged to providesame-dayliquidity. This “Global Core Excess” is intended to allow us to meet immediate obligations without needing to sell other assets or depend on additional funding fromcredit-sensitivemarkets. We believe that this pool of excess liquidity provides us with a resilient source of funds and gives us significant flexibility in managing through a difficult funding environment. Our Global Core Excess reflects the following principles:
 
  • The first days or weeks of a liquidity crisis are the most critical to a company’s survival.
 
  • Focus must be maintained on all potential cash and collateral outflows, not just disruptions to financing flows. Our businesses are diverse, and our cash needs are driven by many factors, including market movements, collateral requirements and client commitments, all of which can change dramatically in a difficult funding environment.
 
  • During a liquidity crisis,credit-sensitivefunding, including unsecured debt and some types of secured financing agreements, may be unavailable, and the terms or availability of other types of secured financing may change.
 
  • As a result of our policy topre-fundliquidity that we estimate may be needed in a crisis, we hold more unencumbered securities and have larger debt balances than our businesses would otherwise require. We believe that our liquidity is stronger with greater balances of highly liquid unencumbered securities, even though it increases our total assets, and our funding costs.

128


Table of Contents

 
The size of our Global Core Excess is based on an internal liquidity model together with a qualitative assessment of the condition of the financial markets and of Goldman Sachs. Our liquidity model, through which we analyze the consolidated firm as well as our majorbroker-dealerand bank depository institution subsidiaries, identifies and estimates potential contractual and contingent cash and collateral outflows over ashort-termhorizon in a liquidity crisis, including, but not limited to:
 
  • upcoming maturities of unsecuredlong-termdebt, promissory notes, commercial paper, term deposits and other unsecured funding products;
 
  • potential buybacks of a portion of our outstanding unsecured funding;
 
  • potential withdrawals of client deposits in our banking entities;
 
  • adverse changes in the terms of, or the inability to refinance, secured funding trades with upcoming maturities, reflecting, among other factors, the quality of the underlying collateral and counterparty concentration;
 
  • outflows of cash or collateral associated with the impact of market moves on our OTC derivatives, listed derivatives and securities and loans pledged as collateral for financing transactions;
 
  • other outflows of cash or collateral related to derivatives, including the impact of trade terminations, collateral substitutions, collateral disputes, collateral calls or termination payments (in the event of atwo-notchdowngrade in our credit ratings), collateral that has not been called by counterparties but is available to them, or additional margin that could be requested by exchanges or clearing houses in a stressed environment;
 
  • potential liquidity outflows associated with our prime brokerage business, including those related to customer credit balances;
 
  • draws on our unfunded commitments not supported by William Street Funding Corporation (1), with draw assumptions varying in magnitude reflecting, among other things, the type of commitment and counterparty, and
 
  • other upcoming cash outflows, such as tax and other large payments.
 
The following table sets forth the average loan value of the securities (the estimated amount of cash that would be advanced by counterparties against these securities), as well as certain overnight cash deposits that are included in our Global Core Excess:
 
         
  Three Months
 Year Ended
  Ended March December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
U.S. dollar-denominated
 $111,258  $120,970 
Non-U.S. dollar-denominated
  50,343   45,404 
         
Total Global Core Excess
 $161,601  $166,374 
         
 
 
TheU.S. dollar-denominatedexcess is comprised of only unencumbered U.S. government securities, U.S. agency securities and highly liquid U.S. agencymortgage-backedsecurities, all of which are eligible as collateral in Federal Reserve open market operations, as well as certain overnight cash deposits. Ournon-U.S. dollar-denominatedexcess is comprised of only unencumbered French, German, United Kingdom and Japanese government bonds and certain overnight cash deposits in highly liquid currencies. We strictly limit our Global Core Excess to this narrowly defined
 
 
(1) The Global Core Excess excludes liquid assets of $4.03 billion held separately by William Street Funding Corporation. See Note 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding the William Street credit extension program.
     

129


Table of Contents

list of securities and cash because we believe they are highly liquid, even in a difficult funding environment. We do not believe that other potential sources of excess liquidity, such as lower-quality unencumbered securities or committed credit facilities, are as reliable in a liquidity crisis.
 
We maintain our Global Core Excess to enable us to meet current and potential liquidity requirements of our parent company, Group Inc., and all of its subsidiaries. The Global Core Excess is held at Group Inc. and our majorbroker-dealerand bank depository institution subsidiaries. Each of these entities has its own liquidity model and funding risk management framework with separate excess liquidity pools intended to meet potential outflows in each entity in a stressed environment. Liquidity held in each of these subsidiaries is assumed to be usable only by that entity for the purpose of meeting its liquidity requirements. Subsidiary liquidity is not available to Group Inc. unless legally provided for and there are no additional regulatory, tax or other restrictions.
 
In addition to our Global Core Excess, we have a significant amount of other unencumbered securities as a result of our business activities. These assets include other government bonds,high-grademoney market securities, corporate bonds and marginable equities. We do not include these securities in our Global Core Excess.
 
In reporting our Global Core Excess and other unencumbered assets, we use loan values that are based onstress-scenarioborrowing capacity and we regularly review these assumptions asset class by asset class. The estimated aggregate loan value of our Global Core Excess, cash deposits not included in the Global Core Excess and our other unencumbered assets averaged $207.10 billion and $210.48 billion for the three months ended March 2010 and year ended December 2009, respectively.
 
Asset-LiabilityManagement
 
Assets.  We seek to maintain a liquid balance sheet and substantially all of our inventory ismarked-to-marketdaily. We impose balance sheet limits for each business and utilize aged inventory limits for certain financial instruments as a disincentive to our businesses to hold inventory over longer periods of time. Although our balance sheet fluctuates due to client activity, market conventions and periodic market opportunities in certain of our businesses, our total assets and adjusted assets at financial statement dates are typically not materially different from those occurring within our reporting periods.
 
Liabilities.  We seek to structure our liabilities to meet the following objectives:
 
  • Term Structure.  We seek to structure our liabilities to havelong-datedmaturities in order to reduce refinancing risk. We manage maturity concentrations for both secured and unsecured funding to ensure we are able to mitigate any concentrated funding outflows.
 
  • Diversity of Funding Sources.  We seek to maintain broad and diversified funding sources globally for both secured and unsecured funding. We make use of the repurchase agreement and securities lending markets, as well as other secured funding markets. We issuelong-termdebt through syndicated U.S. registered offerings, U.S. registered and 144Amedium-termnote programs, offshoremedium-termnote offerings and other debt offerings. We issueshort-termdebt through U.S. andnon-U.S. commercialpaper and promissory note issuances and other methods. We raise demand and savings deposits through cash sweep programs and time deposits through internal andthird-partybroker networks. We generally distribute our funding products through our own sales force to a large, diverse global creditor base. We believe that our relationships with our creditors are critical to our liquidity. Our creditors include banks, governments, securities lenders, pension funds, insurance companies, mutual funds and individuals. We access funding in a variety of markets in the Americas, Europe and Asia. We have imposed various internal guidelines on creditor concentration, including the amount of our commercial paper and promissory notes that can be owned by any single creditor or group of creditors.

130


Table of Contents

 
  • Structural Protection.  We structure our liabilities to reduce the risk that we may be required to redeem or repurchase certain of our borrowings prior to their contractual maturity. We issue substantially all of our unsecured debt without put provisions or other provisions that would, based solely upon an adverse change in our credit ratings, financial ratios, earnings, cash flows or stock price, trigger a requirement for an early payment, collateral support, change in terms, acceleration of maturity or the creation of an additional financial obligation.
 
Secured Funding.  We fund a substantial portion of our inventory on a secured basis, which we believe provides us with a more stable source of liquidity than unsecured financing, as it is less sensitive to changes in our credit quality due to the underlying collateral. However, we recognize that the terms or availability of secured funding, particularly overnight funding, can deteriorate rapidly in a difficult environment. To help mitigate this risk, we generally do not rely on overnight secured funding, unless collateralized with highly liquid securities such as securities eligible for inclusion in our Global Core Excess. Substantially all of our other secured funding is executed for tenors of one month or greater. Additionally, we monitor counterparty concentration and hold a portion of our Global Core Excess for refinancing risk associated with all secured funding transactions. We seek longer terms for secured funding collateralized by lower-quality assets, as we believe these funding transactions may pose greater refinancing risk. The weighted average life of our secured funding, excluding funding collateralized by highly liquid securities eligible for inclusion in our Global Core Excess, exceeded 100 days as of March 2010.
 
UnsecuredShort-TermBorrowings.  Our liquidity also depends on the stability of our unsecuredshort-termfinancing base. Accordingly, we prefer issuing promissory notes, in which we do not make a market, over commercial paper, which we may repurchase prior to maturity through the ordinary course of business as a market maker. As of March 2010, our unsecuredshort-termborrowings, including the current portion of unsecuredlong-termborrowings, were $40.78 billion. See Note 6 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding our unsecuredshort-termborrowings.

131


Table of Contents

UnsecuredLong-TermBorrowings.  We issue unsecuredlong-termborrowings as a source of total capital in order to meet ourlong-termfinancing requirements. The following table sets forth our quarterly unsecuredlong-termborrowings maturity profile through the first quarter of 2016 as of March 2010:
 
UnsecuredLong-TermBorrowings Maturity Profile
($ in millions)
 
 
 
The weighted average maturity of our unsecuredlong-termborrowings as of March 2010 was approximately seven years. To mitigate refinancing risk, we seek to limit the principal amount of debt maturing on any one day or during any week or year. We swap a substantial portion of ourlong-termborrowings intoshort-termfloating rate obligations in order to minimize our exposure to interest rates.
 
Deposits.  As of March 2010, our bank depository institution subsidiaries had $38.43 billion in customer deposits, including $9.46 billion of certificates of deposit and other time deposits with a weighted average maturity of three years, and $28.97 billion of other deposits, substantially all of which were from cash sweep programs. GS Bank USA has access to funding through the Federal Reserve Bank discount window. While we do not rely on funding through the Federal Reserve Bank discount window in our liquidity modeling and stress testing, we maintain policies and procedures necessary to access this funding.
 
Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (TLGP).  As of March 2010, we had outstanding $20.69 billion of senior unsecured debt (comprised of $3.73 billion ofshort-termand $16.96 billion oflong-term)guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP, all of which will mature on or prior to June 15, 2012. We have not issuedlong-termdebt under the TLGP since March 2009 and the program has expired for new issuances.

132


Table of Contents

See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor a discussion of factors that could impair our ability to access the capital markets.
 
Funding Policies.  We seek to manage our assets and the maturity profile of our secured and unsecured funding base such that we should be able to liquidate our assets prior to our liabilities coming due, even in times of prolonged or severe liquidity stress.
 
In order to avoid reliance on asset sales (other than our Global Core Excess), our goal is to ensure that we have sufficient total capital (unsecuredlong-termborrowings plus total shareholders’ equity) to fund our balance sheet for at least one year. However, we recognize that orderly asset sales may be prudent or necessary in a severe or persistent liquidity crisis. The target amount of our total capital is based on an internal funding model which incorporates, among other things, the followinglong-termfinancing requirements:
 
  • the portion of trading assets that we believe could not be funded on a secured basis in periods of market stress, assuming stressed loan values;
 
  • goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, property, leasehold improvements and equipment, and other illiquid assets;
 
  • derivative and other margin and collateral requirements;
 
  • anticipated draws on our unfunded loan commitments; and
 
  • capital or other forms of financing in our regulated subsidiaries that are in excess of theirlong-termfinancing requirements.
 
Certain financial instruments may be more difficult to fund on a secured basis during times of market stress. Accordingly, we focus on funding these assets with longer contractual maturities to reduce refinancing risk in periods of market stress and generally hold higher levels of total capital for these assets than more liquid types of financial instruments. The following table sets forth our aggregate holdings in these categories of financial instruments:
 
         
  As of
  March
 December
  2010 2009
  (in millions)
Mortgage and otherasset-backedloans and securities
 $13,236  $14,277 
Bank loans and bridge loans (1)
  20,787   19,345 
Emerging market debt securities
  2,736   2,957 
High-yieldand other debt obligations
  12,866   12,028 
Private equity investments and real estate fund investments (2)
  13,182   14,633 
Emerging market equity securities
  5,835   5,193 
ICBC ordinary shares (3)
  7,538   8,111 
SMFG convertible preferred stock (4)
     933 
Other restricted public equity securities
  99   203 
Other investments in funds (5)
  3,031   2,911 
 
 
  (1) Includes funded commitments and inventory held in connection with our origination and secondary trading activities.
 
  (2) Includes interests in our merchant banking funds. Such amounts exclude assets related to consolidated investment funds of $1.03 billion and $919 million as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, for which Goldman Sachs does not bear economic exposure. Excludes $1.29 billion as of March 2010, related to VIEs consolidated upon adoption of ASUNo. 2009-17,for which Goldman Sachs does not bear economic exposure.
 
  (3) Includes interests of $4.76 billion and $5.13 billion as of March 2010 and December 2009, respectively, held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs.
 
  (4) During the first quarter of 2010, we converted our remaining SMFG preferred stock investment into common stock and delivered the common stock to close out our related hedge position.
 
  (5) Includes interests in other investment funds that we manage.

133


Table of Contents

See Note 3 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor further information regarding the financial instruments we hold.
 
Subsidiary Funding Policies.  The majority of our unsecured funding is raised by Group Inc. Group Inc. then lends the necessary funds to its subsidiaries, some of which are regulated, to meet their asset financing, liquidity and capital requirements. In addition, Group Inc. provides its regulated subsidiaries with the necessary capital to meet their regulatory requirements. The benefits of this approach to subsidiary funding include enhanced control and greater flexibility to meet the funding requirements of our subsidiaries. Funding is also raised at the subsidiary level through a variety of products, including secured funding, unsecured borrowings and deposits.
 
Our intercompany funding policies are predicated on an assumption that, unless legally provided for, funds or securities are not freely available from a subsidiary to its parent company or other subsidiaries. In particular, many of our subsidiaries are subject to laws that authorize regulatory bodies to block or reduce the flow of funds from those subsidiaries to Group Inc. Regulatory action of that kind could impede access to funds that Group Inc. needs to make payments on obligations, including debt obligations. As such, we assume that capital or other financing provided to our regulated subsidiaries is not available to Group Inc. or other subsidiaries until the maturity of such financing.
 
Group Inc. has provided substantial amounts of equity and subordinated indebtedness, directly or indirectly, to its regulated subsidiaries. For example, as of March 2010, Group Inc. had $26.21 billion of such equity and subordinated indebtedness invested in GS&Co., its principal U.S. registeredbroker-dealer;$22.96 billion invested in GSI, a regulated U.K.broker-dealer;$2.65 billion invested in Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P., a U.S. registeredbroker-dealer;$3.84 billion invested in Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd., a regulated Japanesebroker-dealer;and $22.86 billion invested in GS Bank USA, a regulated New York State-chartered bank. Group Inc. also had $81.55 billion of unsubordinated loans and $14.84 billion of collateral provided to these entities as of March 2010, as well as significant amounts of capital invested in and loans to its other regulated subsidiaries.
 
Contingency Funding Plan
 
The Goldman Sachs CFP sets out the plan of action to fund business activity in crisis situationsand/orperiods of market stress. The CFP outlines the appropriate communication channels to be followed throughout a crisis period and also provides a framework for analyzing and responding to a liquidity crisis including, but not limited to, the potential risk factors, identification of liquidity outflows, mitigants and potential actions.

134


Table of Contents

Credit Ratings
 
The following table sets forth our unsecured credit ratings (excluding debt guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP) and outlook as of March 2010:
 
             
  Short-Term
 Long-Term
 Subordinated
 Trust
 Preferred
 Rating
  Debt Debt Debt Preferred(1) Stock (2) Outlook
DBRS, Inc. 
 R-1 (middle) A (high) A A BBB Stable (5)
Fitch, Inc.(3)
 F1+ A+ A A- A- Stable (6)
Moody’s Investors Service (4)
 P-1 A1 A2 A3 Baa2 Negative (7)
Standard & Poors Ratings Services
 A-1 A A- BBB BBB Negative (7)
Rating and Investment Information, Inc. 
 a-1+ AA- A+ Not Applicable Not Applicable Negative (8)
 
 
  (1) Trust preferred securities issued by Goldman Sachs Capital I.
 
  (2) Includes Group Inc.’snon-cumulativepreferred stock and the Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities (APEX) issued by Goldman Sachs Capital II and Goldman Sachs Capital III.
 
  (3) GS Bank USA has been assigned a rating of AA- forlong-termbank deposits, F1+ forshort-termbank deposits and A+ forlong-termissuer.
 
  (4) GS Bank USA has been assigned a rating of Aa3 forlong-termbank deposits,P-1 forshort-termbank deposits and Aa3 forlong-termissuer.
 
  (5) Applies tolong-termandshort-termratings.
 
  (6) Applies tolong-termissuer default ratings.
 
  (7) Applies tolong-termratings.
 
  (8) Applies to issuer rating.
 
 
On May 5, 2010, Fitch, Inc. affirmed Group Inc.’s long-term and short-term issuer default ratings but revised its Rating Outlook from “Stable” to “Negative.”
 
We rely upon the short-term and long-term debt capital markets to fund a significant portion of our day-to-day operations. The cost and availability of debt financing is influenced by our credit ratings. Credit ratings are important when we are competing in certain markets and when we seek to engage in longer-term transactions, including OTC derivatives. See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor a discussion of the risks associated with a reduction in our credit ratings.
 
We believe our credit ratings are primarily based on the credit rating agencies’ assessment of our liquidity, market, credit and operational risk management practices, the level and variability of our earnings, our capital base, our franchise, reputation and management, our corporate governance and the external operating environment, including the assumed level of government support. Recently, certain rating agencies have indicated that the enactment of financial regulatory reform legislation in the U.S. could result in the rating agencies reducing their assumed level of government support and therefore result in ratings downgrades for certain large financial institutions. However, this legislation is still in the proposal stage and any actions to be taken by the rating agencies have not been determined.
 
In evaluating our liquidity requirements, we consider additional collateral or termination payments that may be required in the event of a two-notch reduction in our long-term credit ratings, as well as collateral that has not been called by counterparties, but is available to them. Based on our credit ratings as of March 2010, additional collateral or termination payments pursuant to bilateral agreements with certain counterparties of approximately $1.51 billion and $2.77 billion could have been called by counterparties in the event of a one-notch and two-notch reduction, respectively, in our long-term credit ratings.

135


Table of Contents

Cash Flows
 
As a global financial institution, our cash flows are complex and interrelated and bear little relation to our net earnings and net assets and, consequently, we believe that traditional cash flow analysis is less meaningful in evaluating our liquidity position than the excess liquidity andasset-liabilitymanagement policies described above. Cash flow analysis may, however, be helpful in highlighting certain macro trends and strategic initiatives in our businesses.
 
Three Months Ended March 2010.  Our cash and cash equivalents decreased by $11.23 billion to $27.06 billion at the end of the first quarter of 2010. We used net cash of $8.47 billion in our operating and investing activities, primarily to fund securities borrowed and securities purchased under agreements to resell. We used net cash in financing activities of $2.76 billion, primarily due to repurchases of common stock.
 
Three Months Ended March 2009.  Our cash and cash equivalents increased by $21.61 billion to $35.42 billion at the end of the first quarter of 2009. We raised $22.52 billion in net cash from operating and financing activities, primarily in bank deposits and unsecuredlong-termborrowings. We used net cash of $913 million in our investing activities.
 
Balance Sheet
 
As of March 2010, total assets on our condensed consolidated statement of financial condition were $880.53 billion, an increase of $31.59 billion from December 2009. Consistent with the activity described in“— CashFlows” above, the $31.59 billion increase is primarily attributable to (i) an increase in securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold of $22.09 billion, primarily due to an increase in our matched book business within Trading and Principal Investments related to an increase in client-driven activity and (ii) an increase in securities borrowed of $12.90 billion, primarily related to client-driven activity.
 
As of March 2010, total liabilities on our condensed consolidated statement of financial condition were $807.58 billion, an increase of $29.36 billion from December 2009. The $29.36 billion increase is primarily attributable to (i) an increase in securities sold under agreements to repurchase of $25.16 billion, primarily due to an increase in our matched book business within Trading and Principal Investments related to an increase in client-driven activity, (ii) an increase in trading liabilities, at fair value of $11.06 billion, primarily due to increases in equities and convertible debentures, andnon-U.S. governmentobligations and (iii) a decrease in other liabilities and accrued expenses of $4.12 billion (see Note 12 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for additional information on “Other liabilities and accrued expenses”).
 
Recent Accounting Developments
 
See Note 2 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Qfor information regarding Recent Accounting Developments.

136


Table of Contents

 
Cautionary Statement Pursuant to the U.S. Private Securities
Litigation Reform Act of 1995
 
We have included or incorporated by reference in this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Q,and from time to time our management may make, statements that may constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the safe harbor provisions of the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements are not historical facts but instead represent only our beliefs regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and outside our control. It is possible that our actual results and financial condition may differ, possibly materially, from the anticipated results and financial condition indicated in these forward-looking statements. For a discussion of some of the risks and important factors that could affect our future results and financial condition, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009 and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009.
 
Statements about our investment banking transaction backlog also may constitute forward-looking statements. Such statements are subject to the risk that the terms of these transactions may be modified or that they may not be completed at all; therefore, the net revenues, if any, that we actually earn from these transactions may differ, possibly materially, from those currently expected. Important factors that could result in a modification of the terms of a transaction or a transaction not being completed include, in the case of underwriting transactions, a decline or weakness in general economic conditions, outbreak of hostilities, volatility in the securities markets generally or an adverse development with respect to the issuer of the securities and, in the case of financial advisory transactions, a decline in the securities markets, an inability to obtain adequate financing, an adverse development with respect to a party to the transaction or a failure to obtain a required regulatory approval. For a discussion of other important factors that could adversely affect our investment banking transactions, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009 and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009.
 
Item 3:  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
 
Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk are set forth under “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Market Risk” in Part I, Item 2 above.
 
Item 4:  Controls and Procedures
 
As of the end of the period covered by this report, an evaluation was carried out by Goldman Sachs’ management, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined inRule 13a-15(e)under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (Exchange Act)). Based upon that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that these disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report. In addition, no change in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined inRule 13a-15(f)under the Exchange Act) occurred during our most recent quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

137


Table of Contents

 
PART II: OTHER INFORMATION
 
Item 1:  Legal Proceedings
 
We are involved in a number of judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings (including those described below) concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of our businesses. We believe, based on currently available information, that the results of such proceedings, in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, but might be material to our operating results for any particular period, depending, in part, upon the operating results for such period. Given the range of litigation and investigations presently under way, our litigation expenses can be expected to remain high. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Use of Estimates” in Part I, Item 2 of this Quarterly Report onForm 10-Q.
 
The following supplements and amends our discussion set forth under Item 3 “Legal Proceedings” in our Annual Report onForm 10-Kfor the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009.
 
IPO Process Matters.  In the lawsuit brought by an official committee of unsecured creditors on behalf of eToys, Inc., GS&Co. moved for summary judgment on March 19, 2010.
 
Enron Litigation Matters.  In the Texas federal court litigation relating to the Exchangeable Notes of Enron Corp., no appeal was taken from the final judgment approving the settlement in the class action, disposing of the matter. In the separate action brought by several funds that invested in the Exchangeable Notes and Zero Coupon Convertible Notes of Enron Corp., the funds did not opt out of the class settlement, and on April 20, 2010 filed a notice discontinuing the individual action with prejudice.
 
Adelphia Communications Fraudulent Conveyance Litigation.  On March 2, 2010, GS&Co. moved for summary judgment.
 
Treasury Matters.  By an order dated April 13, 2010, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Seventh Circuit ruled that GS&Co.’s motion to dismiss the appeal would be entertained together with the merits of the appeal.
 
Refco Securities Litigation.  On April 20, 2010, certain underwriting defendants including GS&Co. entered into a definitive settlement of the class action, pursuant to which they will contribute $49.5 million to a settlement fund. The settlement is subject to court approval.
 
Short-Selling Litigation.  On March 3, 2010, plaintiffs filed a petition in the U.S. Supreme Court seeking review of the appellate court decision affirming dismissal of the complaint.
 
Compensation-Related Litigation.  In the action relating to Group Inc.’s 2007 proxy statement, on March 15, 2010, plaintiff filed a petition in the U.S. Supreme Court seeking review of the appellate court decision affirming dismissal of the complaint.
 
In the action relating to Group Inc.’s 2008 proxy statement, plaintiff filed a further amended complaint on March 24, 2010.

138


Table of Contents

In the actions in New York state court, on April 8, 2010, plaintiffs filed a motion indicating that they no longer intend to pursue their claims but are seeking an award of attorney’s fees in connection with bringing the suit. In the actions brought in the Delaware Court of Chancery, defendants moved to dismiss on March 9, 2010, and plaintiffs amended their complaint on April 28, 2010 to include, among other things, the allegations included in the SEC’s action described under “Mortgage-Related Matters” below.
 
Mortgage-Related Matters.  On March 31, 2010, the plaintiff in the purported class action commenced on December 11, 2008 relating to various mortgage pass-through and asset-backed certificates issued by various securitization trusts in 2007 filed a third amended complaint. On April 26, 2010, an alleged purchaser of asset-backed certificates issued in an offering that is not included in the third amended complaint moved to intervene in the action as an additional plaintiff on behalf of a putative class of purchasers of securities in that offering.
 
On April 16, 2010, the SEC brought an action (SEC Action) under the U.S. federal securities laws in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York against GS&Co. and one of its employees in connection with a CDO offering made in early 2007 (2007 CDO Transaction), alleging that the defendants made materially false and misleading statements to investors and seeking, among other things, unspecified monetary penalties. Notices of investigation subsequently have been received by GS&Co. from FINRA and by GSI from the U.K. Financial Services Authority, and Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates have received requests for information from other regulators regarding CDO offerings, including the 2007 CDO Transaction, and related matters.
 
Since April 22, 2010, a number of putative shareholder derivative actions have been filed in New York Supreme Court, New York County, and the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York against Group Inc., the Board and certain officers and employees of Group Inc. and its affiliates in connection with CDO offerings made between 2004 and 2007, including the 2007 CDO Transaction. These derivative complaints generally include allegations of breach of fiduciary duty, corporate waste, abuse of control, mismanagement, unjust enrichment, misappropriation of information and insider trading, and challenge the accuracy and adequacy of Group Inc.’s disclosure. These derivative complaints seek, among other things, declaratory relief, unspecified compensatory damages, restitution and certain corporate governance reforms. In addition, plaintiffs in the Delaware Court of Chancery actions described in the “Compensation-Related Litigation” section above have amended their complaint to assert, among other things, allegations similar to those in the derivative claims referred to above.
 
Since April 23, 2010, the Board has received letters from shareholders demanding that the Board take action to address alleged misconduct by GS&Co., the Board and certain officers and employees of Group Inc. and its affiliates. The demands generally allege misconduct in connection with the 2007 CDO Transaction, the alleged failure by Group Inc. to adequately disclose the SEC investigation that led to the SEC Action, and Group Inc.’s 2009 compensation practices. The demands include a letter from a Group Inc. shareholder, which previously made a demand that the Board investigate and take action in connection with auction products matters, and has now expanded its demand to address the foregoing matters.
 
In addition, beginning April 26, 2010, a number of purported securities law class actions have been filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York challenging the adequacy of Group Inc.’s public disclosure of, among other things, the firm’s activities in the CDO market and the SEC investigation that led to the SEC Action. The purported class action complaints, which name as defendants Group Inc. and certain officers and employees of Group Inc. and its affiliates, generally allege violations of Sections 10(b) and 20(a) of the Exchange Act and seek unspecified damages.
 
We anticipate that additional putative shareholder derivative actions and other litigation may be filed, and regulatory and other investigations and actions commenced, against us with respect to offerings of CDOs.

139


Table of Contents

To the extent we are unable to obtain appropriate waivers from relevant regulators, resolution of the SEC Action, through a judgment or a settlement that includes an injunction, acease-and-desistorder or a finding of fraud, could result in collateral consequences to us that may materially adversely affect the manner in which we conduct our businesses, including, without limitation, an inability to act as a registered broker-dealer or provide certain advisory and other services to U.S. registered mutual funds. In addition, regulators could impose restrictions on the activities of our banking, commodities, investment advisory or other regulated businesses.
 
Auction Products Matters.  On March 19, 2010, GS&Co. entered into an Administrative Consent Order with the Illinois Secretary of State, Securities Department, which had conducted an investigation on behalf of states other than New York. GS&Co. is in the process of entering into similar consent orders with the other states.
 
In the actions alleging a conspiracy to manipulate the auction securities market in violation of the federal antitrust laws, on March 1, 2010, plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal from the dismissal of their complaints.
 
Washington Mutual Securities Litigation.  Plaintiffs filed their motion for class certification on April 30, 2010.
 
Transactions with the Hellenic Republic (Greece).  Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates are subject to a number of investigations and reviews by various governmental and regulatory bodies and self-regulatory organizations in connection with the firm’s transactions with the Hellenic Republic (Greece), including financing and swap transactions. Goldman Sachs is cooperating with the investigations and reviews.
 
Sales and Trading Practices.  Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates are subject to a number of investigations and reviews by various governmental and regulatory bodies and self-regulatory organizations relating to the sales, trading and clearance of corporate and government securities and other financial products, including compliance with the SEC’s short sale rule, algorithmic and quantitative trading, futures trading, trading of credit derivative instruments, commodities trading and the effectiveness of internal information barriers. Goldman Sachs is cooperating with the investigations and reviews.
 
Municipal Securities Matters.  Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates are subject to a number of investigations and reviews by various governmental and regulatory bodies and self-regulatory organizations relating to transactions involving municipal securities, including wall-cross procedures and conflict of interest disclosure with respect to state and municipal clients, the trading of municipal derivative instruments in connection with municipal offerings and the possible impact of credit default swap transactions on municipal issuers. Goldman Sachs is cooperating with the investigations and reviews.
 
Group Inc., Goldman Sachs Mitsui Marine Derivative Products, L.P. (GSMMDP) and GS Bank USA are among numerous financial services firms that have been named as defendants in six individual antitrust actions filed beginning on November 12, 2009 in the U.S. District Courts for the Central and Eastern Districts of California by multiple California municipalities, which have been coordinated with related antitrust class action litigation and individual actions, in which no Goldman Sachs affiliate is named, for pre-trial proceedings in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. The complaints against Group Inc., GSMMDP and GS Bank USA generally allege that the Goldman Sachs defendants participated in a conspiracy to arrange bids, fix prices and divide up the market for derivatives used by municipalities in refinancing and hedging transactions from 1992 to 2008. The complaints assert claims under the federal antitrust laws and California’s Cartwright Act, and seek, among other things, treble damages under the antitrust laws and injunctive relief. On April 26, 2010, the Goldman Sachs defendants’ motion to dismiss was denied.

140


Table of Contents

Financial Crisis-Related Matters.  Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates are subject to a number of investigations and reviews by various governmental and regulatory bodies and self-regulatory organizations relating to the 2008 financial crisis, including the establishment and unwind of credit default swaps between Goldman Sachs and American International Group, Inc. (AIG) and other transactions with, and in the securities of, AIG, The Bear Stearns Companies Inc., Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc. and other firms. Goldman Sachs is cooperating with the investigations and reviews.
 
Research Matters.  Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates are subject to a number of investigations and reviews by various governmental and regulatory bodies and self-regulatory organizations relating to research practices, including communications among research analysts, sales and trading personnel and clients. Goldman Sachs is cooperating with the investigations and reviews.

141


Table of Contents

Item 2:  Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds
 
The table below sets forth the information with respect to purchases made by or on behalf of Group Inc. or any “affiliated purchaser” (as defined inRule 10b-18(a)(3)under the Exchange Act) of our common stock during the three months ended March 31, 2010.
 
                 
      Total Number of
 Maximum Number
    Average
 Shares Purchased
 of Shares That May
  Total Number
 Price
 as Part of Publicly
 Yet Be Purchased
  of Shares
 Paid per
 Announced Plans
 Under the Plans or
Period       
 Purchased Share or Programs(1) Programs(1)
Month #1
                
(January 1, 2010 to
January 31, 2010)
           60,837,406 
Month #2
                
(February 1, 2010 to
February 28, 2010)
           60,837,406 
Month #3
                
(March 1, 2010 to
March 31, 2010)
  13,180,250  $172.15   13,180,250   47,657,156 
                 
Total
  13,180,250       13,180,250     
                 
 
 
  (1) On March 21, 2000, we announced that our Board had approved a repurchase program, pursuant to which up to 15 million shares of our common stock may be repurchased. This repurchase program was increased by an aggregate of 280 million shares by resolutions of our Board adopted on June 18, 2001, March 18, 2002, November 20, 2002, January 30, 2004, January 25, 2005, September 16, 2005, September 11, 2006 and December 17, 2007. We seek to use our share repurchase program to substantially offset increases in share count over time resulting from employeeshare-basedcompensation and to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity. The repurchase program is effected primarily through regularopen-marketpurchases, the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by our issuance of shares resulting from employeeshare-basedcompensation as well as our current and projected capital position (i.e., comparisons of our desired level of capital to our actual level of capital), but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of our common stock. Any repurchase of our common stock requires approval by the Federal Reserve Board. The total remaining authorization under the repurchase program was 47,657,156 shares as of April 23, 2010; the repurchase program has no set expiration or termination date.

142


Table of Contents

Item 6:  Exhibits
 
     
Exhibits:
 
 
10.1
  General Guarantee Agreement, dated March 2, 2010, made by The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. relating to the obligations of Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P.
    
 
12.1
  Statement re: Computation of Ratios of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Ratios of Earnings to Combined Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.
    
 
15.1
  Letter re: Unaudited Interim Financial Information.
    
 
31.1
  Rule 13a-14(a) Certifications.*
    
 
32.1
  Section 1350 Certifications.*
    
 
101
  Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 ofRegulation S-T:(i) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Earnings for the three months ended March 31, 2010 and March 27, 2009, (ii) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition as of March 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009, (iii) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity for the three months ended March 31, 2010 and year ended December 31, 2009, (iv) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the three months ended March 31, 2010 and March 27, 2009, (v) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the three months ended March 31, 2010 and March 27, 2009, and (vi) the notes to the Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, tagged as blocks of text.*
 
 
This information is furnished and not filed for purposes of Sections 11 and 12 of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

143


Table of Contents

 
SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.
 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC.
 
  By: 
/s/  David A. Viniar
Name: David A. Viniar
  Title: Chief Financial Officer
 
  By: 
/s/  Sarah E. Smith
Name: Sarah E. Smith
  Title: Principal Accounting Officer
 
Date: May 7, 2010

144